blob: 51ef01fce864d853c6b090fbbaf34a9f79bd9268 [file] [log] [blame]
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001//===--- SemaExpr.cpp - Semantic Analysis for Expressions -----------------===//
2//
3// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
Chris Lattner0bc735f2007-12-29 19:59:25 +00005// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007//
8//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9//
10// This file implements semantic analysis for expressions.
11//
12//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13
John McCall2d887082010-08-25 22:03:47 +000014#include "clang/Sema/SemaInternal.h"
Douglas Gregore737f502010-08-12 20:07:10 +000015#include "clang/Sema/Initialization.h"
16#include "clang/Sema/Lookup.h"
17#include "clang/Sema/AnalysisBasedWarnings.h"
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000018#include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
Douglas Gregorcc8a5d52010-04-29 00:18:15 +000019#include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h"
Daniel Dunbarc4a1dea2008-08-11 05:35:13 +000020#include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +000021#include "clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h"
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +000022#include "clang/AST/EvaluatedExprVisitor.h"
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +000023#include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
Chris Lattner04421082008-04-08 04:40:51 +000024#include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
Steve Narofff494b572008-05-29 21:12:08 +000025#include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h"
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +000026#include "clang/AST/RecursiveASTVisitor.h"
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +000027#include "clang/AST/TypeLoc.h"
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +000028#include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h"
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000029#include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h"
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000030#include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h"
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +000031#include "clang/Lex/LiteralSupport.h"
32#include "clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h"
John McCall19510852010-08-20 18:27:03 +000033#include "clang/Sema/DeclSpec.h"
34#include "clang/Sema/Designator.h"
35#include "clang/Sema/Scope.h"
John McCall781472f2010-08-25 08:40:02 +000036#include "clang/Sema/ScopeInfo.h"
John McCall19510852010-08-20 18:27:03 +000037#include "clang/Sema/ParsedTemplate.h"
John McCall7cd088e2010-08-24 07:21:54 +000038#include "clang/Sema/Template.h"
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000039using namespace clang;
John McCall781472f2010-08-25 08:40:02 +000040using namespace sema;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000041
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +000042
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000043/// \brief Determine whether the use of this declaration is valid, and
44/// emit any corresponding diagnostics.
45///
46/// This routine diagnoses various problems with referencing
47/// declarations that can occur when using a declaration. For example,
48/// it might warn if a deprecated or unavailable declaration is being
49/// used, or produce an error (and return true) if a C++0x deleted
50/// function is being used.
51///
Chris Lattner52338262009-10-25 22:31:57 +000052/// If IgnoreDeprecated is set to true, this should not want about deprecated
53/// decls.
54///
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000055/// \returns true if there was an error (this declaration cannot be
56/// referenced), false otherwise.
Chris Lattner52338262009-10-25 22:31:57 +000057///
John McCall54abf7d2009-11-04 02:18:39 +000058bool Sema::DiagnoseUseOfDecl(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc) {
Chris Lattner76a642f2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000059 // See if the decl is deprecated.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40b598e2009-06-30 02:34:44 +000060 if (D->getAttr<DeprecatedAttr>()) {
John McCall54abf7d2009-11-04 02:18:39 +000061 EmitDeprecationWarning(D, Loc);
Chris Lattner76a642f2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000062 }
63
Chris Lattnerffb93682009-10-25 17:21:40 +000064 // See if the decl is unavailable
65 if (D->getAttr<UnavailableAttr>()) {
Ted Kremenek042411c2010-07-21 20:43:11 +000066 Diag(Loc, diag::err_unavailable) << D->getDeclName();
Chris Lattnerffb93682009-10-25 17:21:40 +000067 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << 0;
68 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +000069
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000070 // See if this is a deleted function.
Douglas Gregor25d944a2009-02-24 04:26:15 +000071 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000072 if (FD->isDeleted()) {
73 Diag(Loc, diag::err_deleted_function_use);
74 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << true;
75 return true;
76 }
Douglas Gregor25d944a2009-02-24 04:26:15 +000077 }
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000078
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000079 return false;
Chris Lattner76a642f2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000080}
81
Fariborz Jahanian5b530052009-05-13 18:09:35 +000082/// DiagnoseSentinelCalls - This routine checks on method dispatch calls
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000083/// (and other functions in future), which have been declared with sentinel
Fariborz Jahanian5b530052009-05-13 18:09:35 +000084/// attribute. It warns if call does not have the sentinel argument.
85///
86void Sema::DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000087 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40b598e2009-06-30 02:34:44 +000088 const SentinelAttr *attr = D->getAttr<SentinelAttr>();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000089 if (!attr)
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +000090 return;
Douglas Gregor92e986e2010-04-22 16:44:27 +000091
92 // FIXME: In C++0x, if any of the arguments are parameter pack
93 // expansions, we can't check for the sentinel now.
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +000094 int sentinelPos = attr->getSentinel();
95 int nullPos = attr->getNullPos();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000096
Mike Stump390b4cc2009-05-16 07:39:55 +000097 // FIXME. ObjCMethodDecl and FunctionDecl need be derived from the same common
98 // base class. Then we won't be needing two versions of the same code.
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +000099 unsigned int i = 0;
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000100 bool warnNotEnoughArgs = false;
101 int isMethod = 0;
102 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D)) {
103 // skip over named parameters.
104 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = MD->param_end();
105 for (P = MD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
106 if (nullPos)
107 --nullPos;
108 else
109 ++i;
110 }
111 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
112 isMethod = 1;
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000113 } else if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000114 // skip over named parameters.
115 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = FD->param_end();
116 for (P = FD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
117 if (nullPos)
118 --nullPos;
119 else
120 ++i;
121 }
122 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000123 } else if (VarDecl *V = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahaniandaf04152009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000124 // block or function pointer call.
125 QualType Ty = V->getType();
126 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType() || Ty->isFunctionPointerType()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000127 const FunctionType *FT = Ty->isFunctionPointerType()
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +0000128 ? Ty->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>()
129 : Ty->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Fariborz Jahaniandaf04152009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000130 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FT)) {
131 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
132 unsigned k;
133 for (k = 0; (k != NumArgsInProto && i < NumArgs); k++) {
134 if (nullPos)
135 --nullPos;
136 else
137 ++i;
138 }
139 warnNotEnoughArgs = (k != NumArgsInProto || i >= NumArgs);
140 }
141 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType())
142 isMethod = 2;
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000143 } else
Fariborz Jahaniandaf04152009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000144 return;
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000145 } else
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000146 return;
147
148 if (warnNotEnoughArgs) {
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000149 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000150 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000151 return;
152 }
153 int sentinel = i;
154 while (sentinelPos > 0 && i < NumArgs-1) {
155 --sentinelPos;
156 ++i;
157 }
158 if (sentinelPos > 0) {
159 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000160 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000161 return;
162 }
163 while (i < NumArgs-1) {
164 ++i;
165 ++sentinel;
166 }
167 Expr *sentinelExpr = Args[sentinel];
John McCall8eb662e2010-05-06 23:53:00 +0000168 if (!sentinelExpr) return;
169 if (sentinelExpr->isTypeDependent()) return;
170 if (sentinelExpr->isValueDependent()) return;
Fariborz Jahanian9ccd7252010-07-14 16:37:51 +0000171 if (sentinelExpr->getType()->isAnyPointerType() &&
John McCall8eb662e2010-05-06 23:53:00 +0000172 sentinelExpr->IgnoreParenCasts()->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
173 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
174 return;
175
176 // Unfortunately, __null has type 'int'.
177 if (isa<GNUNullExpr>(sentinelExpr)) return;
178
179 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_missing_sentinel) << isMethod;
180 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian5b530052009-05-13 18:09:35 +0000181}
182
Douglas Gregor4b2d3f72009-02-26 21:00:50 +0000183SourceRange Sema::getExprRange(ExprTy *E) const {
184 Expr *Ex = (Expr *)E;
185 return Ex? Ex->getSourceRange() : SourceRange();
186}
187
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000188//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
189// Standard Promotions and Conversions
190//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
191
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000192/// DefaultFunctionArrayConversion (C99 6.3.2.1p3, C99 6.3.2.1p4).
193void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(Expr *&E) {
194 QualType Ty = E->getType();
195 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayConversion - missing type");
196
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000197 if (Ty->isFunctionType())
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000198 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getPointerType(Ty),
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000199 CK_FunctionToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner67d33d82008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000200 else if (Ty->isArrayType()) {
201 // In C90 mode, arrays only promote to pointers if the array expression is
202 // an lvalue. The relevant legalese is C90 6.2.2.1p3: "an lvalue that has
203 // type 'array of type' is converted to an expression that has type 'pointer
204 // to type'...". In C99 this was changed to: C99 6.3.2.1p3: "an expression
205 // that has type 'array of type' ...". The relevant change is "an lvalue"
206 // (C90) to "an expression" (C99).
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc39a3d72008-09-11 04:25:59 +0000207 //
208 // C++ 4.2p1:
209 // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown bound of
210 // T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to T".
211 //
212 if (getLangOptions().C99 || getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ||
213 E->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid)
Anders Carlsson112a0a82009-08-07 23:48:20 +0000214 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty),
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000215 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner67d33d82008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000216 }
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000217}
218
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000219void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr *&E) {
220 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(E);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000221
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000222 QualType Ty = E->getType();
223 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion - missing type");
224 if (!Ty->isDependentType() && Ty.hasQualifiers() &&
225 (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || !Ty->isRecordType()) &&
226 E->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid) {
227 // C++ [conv.lval]p1:
228 // [...] If T is a non-class type, the type of the rvalue is the
229 // cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the
230 // rvalue is T
231 //
232 // C99 6.3.2.1p2:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000233 // If the lvalue has qualified type, the value has the unqualified
234 // version of the type of the lvalue; otherwise, the value has the
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000235 // type of the lvalue.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000236 ImpCastExprToType(E, Ty.getUnqualifiedType(), CK_NoOp);
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000237 }
238}
239
240
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000241/// UsualUnaryConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to most
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000242/// operators (C99 6.3). The conversions of array and function types are
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000243/// sometimes surpressed. For example, the array->pointer conversion doesn't
244/// apply if the array is an argument to the sizeof or address (&) operators.
245/// In these instances, this routine should *not* be called.
246Expr *Sema::UsualUnaryConversions(Expr *&Expr) {
247 QualType Ty = Expr->getType();
248 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "UsualUnaryConversions - missing type");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000249
Douglas Gregorfc24e442009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000250 // C99 6.3.1.1p2:
251 //
252 // The following may be used in an expression wherever an int or
253 // unsigned int may be used:
254 // - an object or expression with an integer type whose integer
255 // conversion rank is less than or equal to the rank of int
256 // and unsigned int.
257 // - A bit-field of type _Bool, int, signed int, or unsigned int.
258 //
259 // If an int can represent all values of the original type, the
260 // value is converted to an int; otherwise, it is converted to an
261 // unsigned int. These are called the integer promotions. All
262 // other types are unchanged by the integer promotions.
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000263 QualType PTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(Expr);
264 if (!PTy.isNull()) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000265 ImpCastExprToType(Expr, PTy, CK_IntegralCast);
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000266 return Expr;
267 }
Douglas Gregorfc24e442009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000268 if (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType()) {
Eli Friedmana95d7572009-08-19 07:44:53 +0000269 QualType PT = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(Ty);
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000270 ImpCastExprToType(Expr, PT, CK_IntegralCast);
Douglas Gregorfc24e442009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000271 return Expr;
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000272 }
273
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000274 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr);
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000275 return Expr;
276}
277
Chris Lattner05faf172008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000278/// DefaultArgumentPromotion (C99 6.5.2.2p6). Used for function calls that
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000279/// do not have a prototype. Arguments that have type float are promoted to
Chris Lattner05faf172008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000280/// double. All other argument types are converted by UsualUnaryConversions().
281void Sema::DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr) {
282 QualType Ty = Expr->getType();
283 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultArgumentPromotion - missing type");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000284
Chris Lattner05faf172008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000285 // If this is a 'float' (CVR qualified or typedef) promote to double.
Chris Lattner40378332010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000286 if (Ty->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Float))
287 return ImpCastExprToType(Expr, Context.DoubleTy,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000288 CK_FloatingCast);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000289
Chris Lattner05faf172008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000290 UsualUnaryConversions(Expr);
291}
292
Chris Lattner312531a2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000293/// DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion - Like DefaultArgumentPromotion, but
294/// will warn if the resulting type is not a POD type, and rejects ObjC
295/// interfaces passed by value. This returns true if the argument type is
296/// completely illegal.
Chris Lattner40378332010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000297bool Sema::DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr, VariadicCallType CT,
298 FunctionDecl *FDecl) {
Anders Carlssondce5e2c2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000299 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000300
Chris Lattner40378332010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000301 // __builtin_va_start takes the second argument as a "varargs" argument, but
302 // it doesn't actually do anything with it. It doesn't need to be non-pod
303 // etc.
304 if (FDecl && FDecl->getBuiltinID() == Builtin::BI__builtin_va_start)
305 return false;
306
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +0000307 if (Expr->getType()->isObjCObjectType() &&
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000308 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
309 PDiag(diag::err_cannot_pass_objc_interface_to_vararg)
310 << Expr->getType() << CT))
311 return true;
Douglas Gregor75b699a2009-12-12 07:25:49 +0000312
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000313 if (!Expr->getType()->isPODType() &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000314 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000315 PDiag(diag::warn_cannot_pass_non_pod_arg_to_vararg)
316 << Expr->getType() << CT))
317 return true;
Chris Lattner312531a2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000318
319 return false;
Anders Carlssondce5e2c2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000320}
321
322
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000323/// UsualArithmeticConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to
324/// binary operators (C99 6.3.1.8). If both operands aren't arithmetic, this
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000325/// routine returns the first non-arithmetic type found. The client is
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000326/// responsible for emitting appropriate error diagnostics.
327/// FIXME: verify the conversion rules for "complex int" are consistent with
328/// GCC.
329QualType Sema::UsualArithmeticConversions(Expr *&lhsExpr, Expr *&rhsExpr,
330 bool isCompAssign) {
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000331 if (!isCompAssign)
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000332 UsualUnaryConversions(lhsExpr);
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000333
334 UsualUnaryConversions(rhsExpr);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000335
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000336 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000337 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000338 QualType lhs =
339 Context.getCanonicalType(lhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000340 QualType rhs =
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000341 Context.getCanonicalType(rhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000342
343 // If both types are identical, no conversion is needed.
344 if (lhs == rhs)
345 return lhs;
346
347 // If either side is a non-arithmetic type (e.g. a pointer), we are done.
348 // The caller can deal with this (e.g. pointer + int).
349 if (!lhs->isArithmeticType() || !rhs->isArithmeticType())
350 return lhs;
351
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000352 // Perform bitfield promotions.
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000353 QualType LHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lhsExpr);
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000354 if (!LHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
355 lhs = LHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000356 QualType RHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(rhsExpr);
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000357 if (!RHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
358 rhs = RHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
359
Eli Friedmana95d7572009-08-19 07:44:53 +0000360 QualType destType = Context.UsualArithmeticConversionsType(lhs, rhs);
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000361 if (!isCompAssign)
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000362 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, destType, CK_Unknown);
363 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, destType, CK_Unknown);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000364 return destType;
365}
366
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000367//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
368// Semantic Analysis for various Expression Types
369//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
370
371
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +0000372/// ActOnStringLiteral - The specified tokens were lexed as pasted string
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000373/// fragments (e.g. "foo" "bar" L"baz"). The result string has to handle string
374/// concatenation ([C99 5.1.1.2, translation phase #6]), so it may come from
375/// multiple tokens. However, the common case is that StringToks points to one
376/// string.
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000377///
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000378ExprResult
Sean Hunt6cf75022010-08-30 17:47:05 +0000379Sema::ActOnStringLiteral(const Token *StringToks, unsigned NumStringToks) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000380 assert(NumStringToks && "Must have at least one string!");
381
Chris Lattnerbbee00b2009-01-16 18:51:42 +0000382 StringLiteralParser Literal(StringToks, NumStringToks, PP);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000383 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000384 return ExprError();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000385
386 llvm::SmallVector<SourceLocation, 4> StringTokLocs;
387 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumStringToks; ++i)
388 StringTokLocs.push_back(StringToks[i].getLocation());
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000389
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000390 QualType StrTy = Context.CharTy;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis55f4b022008-08-09 17:20:01 +0000391 if (Literal.AnyWide) StrTy = Context.getWCharType();
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000392 if (Literal.Pascal) StrTy = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregor77a52232008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000393
394 // A C++ string literal has a const-qualified element type (C++ 2.13.4p1).
Chris Lattner7dc480f2010-06-15 18:05:34 +0000395 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || getLangOptions().ConstStrings)
Douglas Gregor77a52232008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000396 StrTy.addConst();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000397
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000398 // Get an array type for the string, according to C99 6.4.5. This includes
399 // the nul terminator character as well as the string length for pascal
400 // strings.
401 StrTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(StrTy,
Chris Lattnerdbb1ecc2009-02-26 23:01:51 +0000402 llvm::APInt(32, Literal.GetNumStringChars()+1),
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000403 ArrayType::Normal, 0);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000404
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000405 // Pass &StringTokLocs[0], StringTokLocs.size() to factory!
Sean Hunt6cf75022010-08-30 17:47:05 +0000406 return Owned(StringLiteral::Create(Context, Literal.GetString(),
407 Literal.GetStringLength(),
408 Literal.AnyWide, StrTy,
409 &StringTokLocs[0],
410 StringTokLocs.size()));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000411}
412
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000413/// ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference - Return true if a reference inside of
414/// CurBlock to VD should cause it to be snapshotted (as we do for auto
415/// variables defined outside the block) or false if this is not needed (e.g.
416/// for values inside the block or for globals).
417///
Douglas Gregor076ceb02010-03-01 20:44:28 +0000418/// This also keeps the 'hasBlockDeclRefExprs' in the BlockScopeInfo records
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000419/// up-to-date.
420///
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000421static bool ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(Sema &S, BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock,
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000422 ValueDecl *VD) {
423 // If the value is defined inside the block, we couldn't snapshot it even if
424 // we wanted to.
425 if (CurBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
426 return false;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000427
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000428 // If this is an enum constant or function, it is constant, don't snapshot.
429 if (isa<EnumConstantDecl>(VD) || isa<FunctionDecl>(VD))
430 return false;
431
432 // If this is a reference to an extern, static, or global variable, no need to
433 // snapshot it.
434 // FIXME: What about 'const' variables in C++?
435 if (const VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(VD))
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000436 if (!Var->hasLocalStorage())
437 return false;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000438
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000439 // Blocks that have these can't be constant.
440 CurBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
441
442 // If we have nested blocks, the decl may be declared in an outer block (in
443 // which case that outer block doesn't get "hasBlockDeclRefExprs") or it may
444 // be defined outside all of the current blocks (in which case the blocks do
445 // all get the bit). Walk the nesting chain.
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000446 for (unsigned I = S.FunctionScopes.size() - 1; I; --I) {
447 BlockScopeInfo *NextBlock = dyn_cast<BlockScopeInfo>(S.FunctionScopes[I]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000448
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000449 if (!NextBlock)
450 continue;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000451
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000452 // If we found the defining block for the variable, don't mark the block as
453 // having a reference outside it.
454 if (NextBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
455 break;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000456
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000457 // Otherwise, the DeclRef from the inner block causes the outer one to need
458 // a snapshot as well.
459 NextBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
460 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000461
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000462 return true;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000463}
464
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000465
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000466ExprResult
John McCalldbd872f2009-12-08 09:08:17 +0000467Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty, SourceLocation Loc,
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +0000468 const CXXScopeSpec *SS) {
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000469 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo(D->getDeclName(), Loc);
470 return BuildDeclRefExpr(D, Ty, NameInfo, SS);
471}
472
473/// BuildDeclRefExpr - Build a DeclRefExpr.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000474ExprResult
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000475Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty,
476 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
477 const CXXScopeSpec *SS) {
Anders Carlssone2bb2242009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000478 if (Context.getCanonicalType(Ty) == Context.UndeducedAutoTy) {
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000479 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(),
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000480 diag::err_auto_variable_cannot_appear_in_own_initializer)
Anders Carlssone2bb2242009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000481 << D->getDeclName();
482 return ExprError();
483 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000484
Anders Carlssone41590d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000485 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor15dedf02010-04-27 21:10:04 +0000486 if (isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(VD)) {
487 // Non-type template parameters can be referenced anywhere they are
488 // visible.
Douglas Gregor63982352010-07-13 18:40:04 +0000489 Ty = Ty.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
Douglas Gregor15dedf02010-04-27 21:10:04 +0000490 } else if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext)) {
Anders Carlssone41590d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000491 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = MD->getParent()->isLocalClass()) {
492 if (VD->hasLocalStorage() && VD->getDeclContext() != CurContext) {
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000493 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(),
494 diag::err_reference_to_local_var_in_enclosing_function)
Anders Carlssone41590d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000495 << D->getIdentifier() << FD->getDeclName();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000496 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_local_variable_declared_here)
Anders Carlssone41590d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000497 << D->getIdentifier();
498 return ExprError();
499 }
500 }
501 }
502 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000503
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000504 MarkDeclarationReferenced(NameInfo.getLoc(), D);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000505
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000506 return Owned(DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
507 SS? (NestedNameSpecifier *)SS->getScopeRep() : 0,
508 SS? SS->getRange() : SourceRange(),
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000509 D, NameInfo, Ty));
Douglas Gregor1a49af92009-01-06 05:10:23 +0000510}
511
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000512/// \brief Given a field that represents a member of an anonymous
513/// struct/union, build the path from that field's context to the
514/// actual member.
515///
516/// Construct the sequence of field member references we'll have to
517/// perform to get to the field in the anonymous union/struct. The
518/// list of members is built from the field outward, so traverse it
519/// backwards to go from an object in the current context to the field
520/// we found.
521///
522/// \returns The variable from which the field access should begin,
523/// for an anonymous struct/union that is not a member of another
524/// class. Otherwise, returns NULL.
525VarDecl *Sema::BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(FieldDecl *Field,
526 llvm::SmallVectorImpl<FieldDecl *> &Path) {
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000527 assert(Field->getDeclContext()->isRecord() &&
528 cast<RecordDecl>(Field->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()
529 && "Field must be stored inside an anonymous struct or union");
530
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000531 Path.push_back(Field);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000532 VarDecl *BaseObject = 0;
533 DeclContext *Ctx = Field->getDeclContext();
534 do {
535 RecordDecl *Record = cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx);
John McCallbc365c52010-05-21 01:17:40 +0000536 ValueDecl *AnonObject = Record->getAnonymousStructOrUnionObject();
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000537 if (FieldDecl *AnonField = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(AnonObject))
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000538 Path.push_back(AnonField);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000539 else {
540 BaseObject = cast<VarDecl>(AnonObject);
541 break;
542 }
543 Ctx = Ctx->getParent();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000544 } while (Ctx->isRecord() &&
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000545 cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)->isAnonymousStructOrUnion());
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000546
547 return BaseObject;
548}
549
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000550ExprResult
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000551Sema::BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(SourceLocation Loc,
552 FieldDecl *Field,
553 Expr *BaseObjectExpr,
554 SourceLocation OpLoc) {
555 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl *, 4> AnonFields;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000556 VarDecl *BaseObject = BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(Field,
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000557 AnonFields);
558
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000559 // Build the expression that refers to the base object, from
560 // which we will build a sequence of member references to each
561 // of the anonymous union objects and, eventually, the field we
562 // found via name lookup.
563 bool BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000564 Qualifiers BaseQuals;
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000565 if (BaseObject) {
566 // BaseObject is an anonymous struct/union variable (and is,
567 // therefore, not part of another non-anonymous record).
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000568 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, BaseObject);
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +0000569 BaseObjectExpr = new (Context) DeclRefExpr(BaseObject,BaseObject->getType(),
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +0000570 SourceLocation());
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000571 BaseQuals
572 = Context.getCanonicalType(BaseObject->getType()).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000573 } else if (BaseObjectExpr) {
574 // The caller provided the base object expression. Determine
575 // whether its a pointer and whether it adds any qualifiers to the
576 // anonymous struct/union fields we're looking into.
577 QualType ObjectType = BaseObjectExpr->getType();
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +0000578 if (const PointerType *ObjectPtr = ObjectType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000579 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
580 ObjectType = ObjectPtr->getPointeeType();
581 }
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000582 BaseQuals
583 = Context.getCanonicalType(ObjectType).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000584 } else {
585 // We've found a member of an anonymous struct/union that is
586 // inside a non-anonymous struct/union, so in a well-formed
587 // program our base object expression is "this".
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000588 DeclContext *DC = getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
589 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)) {
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000590 if (!MD->isStatic()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000591 QualType AnonFieldType
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000592 = Context.getTagDeclType(
593 cast<RecordDecl>(AnonFields.back()->getDeclContext()));
594 QualType ThisType = Context.getTagDeclType(MD->getParent());
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000595 if ((Context.getCanonicalType(AnonFieldType)
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000596 == Context.getCanonicalType(ThisType)) ||
597 IsDerivedFrom(ThisType, AnonFieldType)) {
598 // Our base object expression is "this".
Douglas Gregor8aa5f402009-12-24 20:23:34 +0000599 BaseObjectExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc,
Douglas Gregor828a1972010-01-07 23:12:05 +0000600 MD->getThisType(Context),
601 /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000602 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
603 }
604 } else {
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000605 return ExprError(Diag(Loc,diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
606 << Field->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000607 }
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000608 BaseQuals = Qualifiers::fromCVRMask(MD->getTypeQualifiers());
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000609 }
610
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000611 if (!BaseObjectExpr)
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000612 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
613 << Field->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000614 }
615
616 // Build the implicit member references to the field of the
617 // anonymous struct/union.
618 Expr *Result = BaseObjectExpr;
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000619 Qualifiers ResultQuals = BaseQuals;
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000620 for (llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl *, 4>::reverse_iterator
621 FI = AnonFields.rbegin(), FIEnd = AnonFields.rend();
622 FI != FIEnd; ++FI) {
623 QualType MemberType = (*FI)->getType();
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000624 Qualifiers MemberTypeQuals =
625 Context.getCanonicalType(MemberType).getQualifiers();
626
627 // CVR attributes from the base are picked up by members,
628 // except that 'mutable' members don't pick up 'const'.
629 if ((*FI)->isMutable())
630 ResultQuals.removeConst();
631
632 // GC attributes are never picked up by members.
633 ResultQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
634
635 // TR 18037 does not allow fields to be declared with address spaces.
636 assert(!MemberTypeQuals.hasAddressSpace());
637
638 Qualifiers NewQuals = ResultQuals + MemberTypeQuals;
639 if (NewQuals != MemberTypeQuals)
640 MemberType = Context.getQualifiedType(MemberType, NewQuals);
641
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000642 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, *FI);
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +0000643 PerformObjectMemberConversion(Result, /*FIXME:Qualifier=*/0, *FI, *FI);
Douglas Gregorbd4c4ae2009-08-26 22:36:53 +0000644 // FIXME: Might this end up being a qualified name?
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +0000645 Result = new (Context) MemberExpr(Result, BaseObjectIsPointer, *FI,
646 OpLoc, MemberType);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000647 BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000648 ResultQuals = NewQuals;
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000649 }
650
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000651 return Owned(Result);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000652}
653
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000654/// Decomposes the given name into a DeclarationNameInfo, its location, and
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000655/// possibly a list of template arguments.
656///
657/// If this produces template arguments, it is permitted to call
658/// DecomposeTemplateName.
659///
660/// This actually loses a lot of source location information for
661/// non-standard name kinds; we should consider preserving that in
662/// some way.
663static void DecomposeUnqualifiedId(Sema &SemaRef,
664 const UnqualifiedId &Id,
665 TemplateArgumentListInfo &Buffer,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000666 DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000667 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *&TemplateArgs) {
668 if (Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_TemplateId) {
669 Buffer.setLAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->LAngleLoc);
670 Buffer.setRAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->RAngleLoc);
671
672 ASTTemplateArgsPtr TemplateArgsPtr(SemaRef,
673 Id.TemplateId->getTemplateArgs(),
674 Id.TemplateId->NumArgs);
675 SemaRef.translateTemplateArguments(TemplateArgsPtr, Buffer);
676 TemplateArgsPtr.release();
677
John McCall2b5289b2010-08-23 07:28:44 +0000678 TemplateName TName = Id.TemplateId->Template.get();
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000679 SourceLocation TNameLoc = Id.TemplateId->TemplateNameLoc;
680 NameInfo = SemaRef.Context.getNameForTemplate(TName, TNameLoc);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000681 TemplateArgs = &Buffer;
682 } else {
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000683 NameInfo = SemaRef.GetNameFromUnqualifiedId(Id);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000684 TemplateArgs = 0;
685 }
686}
687
John McCall4c72d3e2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000688/// Determines whether the given record is "fully-formed" at the given
689/// location, i.e. whether a qualified lookup into it is assured of
690/// getting consistent results already.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000691static bool IsFullyFormedScope(Sema &SemaRef, CXXRecordDecl *Record) {
John McCall4c72d3e2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000692 if (!Record->hasDefinition())
693 return false;
694
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000695 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
696 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
697 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
698 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
699 if (!BaseRT) return false;
700
701 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall4c72d3e2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000702 if (!BaseRecord->hasDefinition() ||
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000703 !IsFullyFormedScope(SemaRef, BaseRecord))
704 return false;
705 }
706
707 return true;
708}
709
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000710/// Determines if the given class is provably not derived from all of
711/// the prospective base classes.
712static bool IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(Sema &SemaRef,
713 CXXRecordDecl *Record,
714 const llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> &Bases) {
John McCallb1b42562009-12-01 22:28:41 +0000715 if (Bases.count(Record->getCanonicalDecl()))
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000716 return false;
717
Douglas Gregor952b0172010-02-11 01:04:33 +0000718 RecordDecl *RD = Record->getDefinition();
John McCallb1b42562009-12-01 22:28:41 +0000719 if (!RD) return false;
720 Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD);
721
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000722 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
723 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
724 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
725 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
726 if (!BaseRT) return false;
727
728 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000729 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef, BaseRecord, Bases))
730 return false;
731 }
732
733 return true;
734}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000735
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000736enum IMAKind {
737 /// The reference is definitely not an instance member access.
738 IMA_Static,
739
740 /// The reference may be an implicit instance member access.
741 IMA_Mixed,
742
743 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
744 /// so, because the context is not an instance method.
745 IMA_Mixed_StaticContext,
746
747 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
748 /// so, because the context is from an unrelated class.
749 IMA_Mixed_Unrelated,
750
751 /// The reference is definitely an implicit instance member access.
752 IMA_Instance,
753
754 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration.
755 IMA_Unresolved,
756
757 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration and the
758 /// context is not an instance method.
759 IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext,
760
761 /// The reference is to a member of an anonymous structure in a
762 /// non-class context.
763 IMA_AnonymousMember,
764
765 /// All possible referrents are instance members and the current
766 /// context is not an instance method.
767 IMA_Error_StaticContext,
768
769 /// All possible referrents are instance members of an unrelated
770 /// class.
771 IMA_Error_Unrelated
772};
773
774/// The given lookup names class member(s) and is not being used for
775/// an address-of-member expression. Classify the type of access
776/// according to whether it's possible that this reference names an
777/// instance member. This is best-effort; it is okay to
778/// conservatively answer "yes", in which case some errors will simply
779/// not be caught until template-instantiation.
780static IMAKind ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(Sema &SemaRef,
781 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +0000782 assert(!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember());
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000783
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000784 DeclContext *DC = SemaRef.getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000785 bool isStaticContext =
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000786 (!isa<CXXMethodDecl>(DC) ||
787 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->isStatic());
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000788
789 if (R.isUnresolvableResult())
790 return isStaticContext ? IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext : IMA_Unresolved;
791
792 // Collect all the declaring classes of instance members we find.
793 bool hasNonInstance = false;
794 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> Classes;
795 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +0000796 NamedDecl *D = *I;
797 if (D->isCXXInstanceMember()) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000798 CXXRecordDecl *R = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
799
800 // If this is a member of an anonymous record, move out to the
801 // innermost non-anonymous struct or union. If there isn't one,
802 // that's a special case.
803 while (R->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) {
804 R = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(R->getParent());
805 if (!R) return IMA_AnonymousMember;
806 }
807 Classes.insert(R->getCanonicalDecl());
808 }
809 else
810 hasNonInstance = true;
811 }
812
813 // If we didn't find any instance members, it can't be an implicit
814 // member reference.
815 if (Classes.empty())
816 return IMA_Static;
817
818 // If the current context is not an instance method, it can't be
819 // an implicit member reference.
820 if (isStaticContext)
821 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed_StaticContext : IMA_Error_StaticContext);
822
823 // If we can prove that the current context is unrelated to all the
824 // declaring classes, it can't be an implicit member reference (in
825 // which case it's an error if any of those members are selected).
826 if (IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef,
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000827 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->getParent(),
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000828 Classes))
829 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed_Unrelated : IMA_Error_Unrelated);
830
831 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed : IMA_Instance);
832}
833
834/// Diagnose a reference to a field with no object available.
835static void DiagnoseInstanceReference(Sema &SemaRef,
836 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
837 const LookupResult &R) {
838 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
839 SourceRange Range(Loc);
840 if (SS.isSet()) Range.setBegin(SS.getRange().getBegin());
841
842 if (R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>()) {
843 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(SemaRef.CurContext)) {
844 if (MD->isStatic()) {
845 // "invalid use of member 'x' in static member function"
846 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
847 << Range << R.getLookupName();
848 return;
849 }
850 }
851
852 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
853 << R.getLookupName() << Range;
854 return;
855 }
856
857 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_call_without_object) << Range;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000858}
859
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000860/// Diagnose an empty lookup.
861///
862/// \return false if new lookup candidates were found
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000863bool Sema::DiagnoseEmptyLookup(Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS, LookupResult &R,
864 CorrectTypoContext CTC) {
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000865 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
866
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000867 unsigned diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_var_use;
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000868 unsigned diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_var_use_suggest;
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000869 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName ||
870 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXLiteralOperatorName ||
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000871 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName) {
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000872 diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_use;
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000873 diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_use_suggest;
874 }
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000875
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000876 // If the original lookup was an unqualified lookup, fake an
877 // unqualified lookup. This is useful when (for example) the
878 // original lookup would not have found something because it was a
879 // dependent name.
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000880 for (DeclContext *DC = SS.isEmpty() ? CurContext : 0;
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000881 DC; DC = DC->getParent()) {
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000882 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) {
883 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
884
885 if (!R.empty()) {
886 // Don't give errors about ambiguities in this lookup.
887 R.suppressDiagnostics();
888
889 CXXMethodDecl *CurMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext);
890 bool isInstance = CurMethod &&
891 CurMethod->isInstance() &&
892 DC == CurMethod->getParent();
893
894 // Give a code modification hint to insert 'this->'.
895 // TODO: fixit for inserting 'Base<T>::' in the other cases.
896 // Actually quite difficult!
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000897 if (isInstance) {
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000898 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(
899 CallsUndergoingInstantiation.back()->getCallee());
Nick Lewyckyd9ca4ab2010-08-20 20:54:15 +0000900 CXXMethodDecl *DepMethod = cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000901 CurMethod->getInstantiatedFromMemberFunction());
Eli Friedmana7e68452010-08-22 01:00:03 +0000902 if (DepMethod) {
Nick Lewyckyd9ca4ab2010-08-20 20:54:15 +0000903 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name
904 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(R.getNameLoc(), "this->");
905 QualType DepThisType = DepMethod->getThisType(Context);
906 CXXThisExpr *DepThis = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(
907 R.getNameLoc(), DepThisType, false);
908 TemplateArgumentListInfo TList;
909 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
910 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TList);
911 CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr *DepExpr =
912 CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create(
913 Context, DepThis, DepThisType, true, SourceLocation(),
914 ULE->getQualifier(), ULE->getQualifierRange(), NULL,
915 R.getLookupNameInfo(), &TList);
916 CallsUndergoingInstantiation.back()->setCallee(DepExpr);
Eli Friedmana7e68452010-08-22 01:00:03 +0000917 } else {
Nick Lewyckyd9ca4ab2010-08-20 20:54:15 +0000918 // FIXME: we should be able to handle this case too. It is correct
919 // to add this-> here. This is a workaround for PR7947.
920 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
Eli Friedmana7e68452010-08-22 01:00:03 +0000921 }
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000922 } else {
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000923 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000924 }
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000925
926 // Do we really want to note all of these?
927 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I)
928 Diag((*I)->getLocation(), diag::note_dependent_var_use);
929
930 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
931 return false;
932 }
Douglas Gregore26f0432010-08-09 22:38:14 +0000933
934 R.clear();
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000935 }
936 }
937
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000938 // We didn't find anything, so try to correct for a typo.
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000939 DeclarationName Corrected;
Daniel Dunbardc32cdf2010-06-02 15:46:52 +0000940 if (S && (Corrected = CorrectTypo(R, S, &SS, 0, false, CTC))) {
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000941 if (!R.empty()) {
942 if (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin())) {
943 if (SS.isEmpty())
944 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName()
945 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
946 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
947 else
948 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
949 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
950 << SS.getRange()
951 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
952 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
953 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
954 Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
955 << ND->getDeclName();
956
957 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
958 return false;
959 }
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +0000960
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000961 if (isa<TypeDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(*R.begin())) {
962 // FIXME: If we ended up with a typo for a type name or
963 // Objective-C class name, we're in trouble because the parser
964 // is in the wrong place to recover. Suggest the typo
965 // correction, but don't make it a fix-it since we're not going
966 // to recover well anyway.
967 if (SS.isEmpty())
968 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName();
969 else
970 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
971 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
972 << SS.getRange();
973
974 // Don't try to recover; it won't work.
975 return true;
976 }
977 } else {
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +0000978 // FIXME: We found a keyword. Suggest it, but don't provide a fix-it
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000979 // because we aren't able to recover.
Douglas Gregord203a162010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000980 if (SS.isEmpty())
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000981 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << Corrected;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000982 else
Douglas Gregord203a162010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000983 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000984 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << Corrected
985 << SS.getRange();
Douglas Gregord203a162010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000986 return true;
987 }
Douglas Gregord203a162010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000988 R.clear();
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000989 }
990
991 // Emit a special diagnostic for failed member lookups.
992 // FIXME: computing the declaration context might fail here (?)
993 if (!SS.isEmpty()) {
994 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
995 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false)
996 << SS.getRange();
997 return true;
998 }
999
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001000 // Give up, we can't recover.
1001 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
1002 return true;
1003}
1004
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001005static ObjCPropertyDecl *OkToSynthesizeProvisionalIvar(Sema &SemaRef,
Fariborz Jahanian73f666f2010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001006 IdentifierInfo *II,
1007 SourceLocation NameLoc) {
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001008 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMeth = SemaRef.getCurMethodDecl();
1009 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = CurMeth->getClassInterface();
1010 if (!IDecl)
1011 return 0;
1012 ObjCImplementationDecl *ClassImpDecl = IDecl->getImplementation();
1013 if (!ClassImpDecl)
1014 return 0;
1015 ObjCPropertyDecl *property = SemaRef.LookupPropertyDecl(IDecl, II);
1016 if (!property)
1017 return 0;
1018 if (ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PIDecl = ClassImpDecl->FindPropertyImplDecl(II))
1019 if (PIDecl->getPropertyImplementation() == ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic)
1020 return 0;
1021 return property;
1022}
1023
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001024static ObjCIvarDecl *SynthesizeProvisionalIvar(Sema &SemaRef,
Fariborz Jahanian73f666f2010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001025 LookupResult &Lookup,
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001026 IdentifierInfo *II,
1027 SourceLocation NameLoc) {
1028 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMeth = SemaRef.getCurMethodDecl();
Fariborz Jahanian73f666f2010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001029 bool LookForIvars;
1030 if (Lookup.empty())
1031 LookForIvars = true;
1032 else if (CurMeth->isClassMethod())
1033 LookForIvars = false;
1034 else
1035 LookForIvars = (Lookup.isSingleResult() &&
1036 Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod());
1037 if (!LookForIvars)
1038 return 0;
1039
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001040 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = CurMeth->getClassInterface();
1041 if (!IDecl)
1042 return 0;
1043 ObjCImplementationDecl *ClassImpDecl = IDecl->getImplementation();
Fariborz Jahanian84ef4b22010-07-19 16:14:33 +00001044 if (!ClassImpDecl)
1045 return 0;
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001046 bool DynamicImplSeen = false;
1047 ObjCPropertyDecl *property = SemaRef.LookupPropertyDecl(IDecl, II);
1048 if (!property)
1049 return 0;
1050 if (ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PIDecl = ClassImpDecl->FindPropertyImplDecl(II))
1051 DynamicImplSeen =
1052 (PIDecl->getPropertyImplementation() == ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic);
1053 if (!DynamicImplSeen) {
Fariborz Jahanian84ef4b22010-07-19 16:14:33 +00001054 QualType PropType = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType(property->getType());
1055 ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = ObjCIvarDecl::Create(SemaRef.Context, ClassImpDecl,
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001056 NameLoc,
1057 II, PropType, /*Dinfo=*/0,
1058 ObjCIvarDecl::Protected,
1059 (Expr *)0, true);
1060 ClassImpDecl->addDecl(Ivar);
1061 IDecl->makeDeclVisibleInContext(Ivar, false);
1062 property->setPropertyIvarDecl(Ivar);
1063 return Ivar;
1064 }
1065 return 0;
1066}
1067
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001068ExprResult Sema::ActOnIdExpression(Scope *S,
John McCallfb97e752010-08-24 22:52:39 +00001069 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1070 UnqualifiedId &Id,
1071 bool HasTrailingLParen,
1072 bool isAddressOfOperand) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001073 assert(!(isAddressOfOperand && HasTrailingLParen) &&
1074 "cannot be direct & operand and have a trailing lparen");
1075
1076 if (SS.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor4c921ae2009-01-30 01:04:22 +00001077 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor5953d8b2009-03-19 17:26:29 +00001078
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001079 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001080
1081 // Decompose the UnqualifiedId into the following data.
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001082 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo;
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001083 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001084 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer, NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
Douglas Gregor5953d8b2009-03-19 17:26:29 +00001085
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001086 DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName();
Douglas Gregor10c42622008-11-18 15:03:34 +00001087 IdentifierInfo *II = Name.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001088 SourceLocation NameLoc = NameInfo.getLoc();
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001089
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001090 // C++ [temp.dep.expr]p3:
1091 // An id-expression is type-dependent if it contains:
Douglas Gregor48026d22010-01-11 18:40:55 +00001092 // -- an identifier that was declared with a dependent type,
1093 // (note: handled after lookup)
1094 // -- a template-id that is dependent,
1095 // (note: handled in BuildTemplateIdExpr)
1096 // -- a conversion-function-id that specifies a dependent type,
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001097 // -- a nested-name-specifier that contains a class-name that
1098 // names a dependent type.
1099 // Determine whether this is a member of an unknown specialization;
1100 // we need to handle these differently.
Eli Friedman647c8b32010-08-06 23:41:47 +00001101 bool DependentID = false;
1102 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName &&
1103 Name.getCXXNameType()->isDependentType()) {
1104 DependentID = true;
1105 } else if (SS.isSet()) {
1106 DeclContext *DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false);
1107 if (DC) {
1108 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC))
1109 return ExprError();
1110 // FIXME: We should be checking whether DC is the current instantiation.
1111 if (CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC))
1112 DependentID = !IsFullyFormedScope(*this, RD);
1113 } else {
1114 DependentID = true;
1115 }
1116 }
1117
1118 if (DependentID) {
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001119 return ActOnDependentIdExpression(SS, NameInfo, isAddressOfOperand,
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001120 TemplateArgs);
1121 }
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001122 bool IvarLookupFollowUp = false;
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001123 // Perform the required lookup.
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001124 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupOrdinaryName);
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001125 if (TemplateArgs) {
Douglas Gregord2235f62010-05-20 20:58:56 +00001126 // Lookup the template name again to correctly establish the context in
1127 // which it was found. This is really unfortunate as we already did the
1128 // lookup to determine that it was a template name in the first place. If
1129 // this becomes a performance hit, we can work harder to preserve those
1130 // results until we get here but it's likely not worth it.
Douglas Gregor1fd6d442010-05-21 23:18:07 +00001131 bool MemberOfUnknownSpecialization;
1132 LookupTemplateName(R, S, SS, QualType(), /*EnteringContext=*/false,
1133 MemberOfUnknownSpecialization);
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001134 } else {
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001135 IvarLookupFollowUp = (!SS.isSet() && II && getCurMethodDecl());
Fariborz Jahanian48c2d562010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001136 LookupParsedName(R, S, &SS, !IvarLookupFollowUp);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001137
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001138 // If this reference is in an Objective-C method, then we need to do
1139 // some special Objective-C lookup, too.
Fariborz Jahanian48c2d562010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001140 if (IvarLookupFollowUp) {
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001141 ExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, II, true));
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001142 if (E.isInvalid())
1143 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001144
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001145 Expr *Ex = E.takeAs<Expr>();
1146 if (Ex) return Owned(Ex);
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001147 // Synthesize ivars lazily
1148 if (getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI2) {
Fariborz Jahanian73f666f2010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001149 if (SynthesizeProvisionalIvar(*this, R, II, NameLoc))
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001150 return ActOnIdExpression(S, SS, Id, HasTrailingLParen,
1151 isAddressOfOperand);
1152 }
Fariborz Jahanianf759b4d2010-08-13 18:09:39 +00001153 // for further use, this must be set to false if in class method.
1154 IvarLookupFollowUp = getCurMethodDecl()->isInstanceMethod();
Steve Naroffe3e9add2008-06-02 23:03:37 +00001155 }
Chris Lattner8a934232008-03-31 00:36:02 +00001156 }
Douglas Gregorc71e28c2009-02-16 19:28:42 +00001157
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001158 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1159 return ExprError();
1160
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001161 // Determine whether this name might be a candidate for
1162 // argument-dependent lookup.
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001163 bool ADL = UseArgumentDependentLookup(SS, R, HasTrailingLParen);
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001164
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001165 if (R.empty() && !ADL) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001166 // Otherwise, this could be an implicitly declared function reference (legal
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001167 // in C90, extension in C99, forbidden in C++).
1168 if (HasTrailingLParen && II && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
1169 NamedDecl *D = ImplicitlyDefineFunction(NameLoc, *II, S);
1170 if (D) R.addDecl(D);
1171 }
1172
1173 // If this name wasn't predeclared and if this is not a function
1174 // call, diagnose the problem.
1175 if (R.empty()) {
Douglas Gregor91f7ac72010-05-18 16:14:23 +00001176 if (DiagnoseEmptyLookup(S, SS, R, CTC_Unknown))
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001177 return ExprError();
1178
1179 assert(!R.empty() &&
1180 "DiagnoseEmptyLookup returned false but added no results");
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001181
1182 // If we found an Objective-C instance variable, let
1183 // LookupInObjCMethod build the appropriate expression to
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001184 // reference the ivar.
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001185 if (ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = R.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>()) {
1186 R.clear();
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001187 ExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, Ivar->getIdentifier()));
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001188 assert(E.isInvalid() || E.get());
1189 return move(E);
1190 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001191 }
1192 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001193
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001194 // This is guaranteed from this point on.
1195 assert(!R.empty() || ADL);
1196
1197 if (VarDecl *Var = R.getAsSingle<VarDecl>()) {
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001198 if (getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI && IvarLookupFollowUp &&
Fariborz Jahanianb1d58e32010-07-29 16:53:53 +00001199 !getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI2 &&
1200 Var->isFileVarDecl()) {
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001201 ObjCPropertyDecl *Property =
1202 OkToSynthesizeProvisionalIvar(*this, II, NameLoc);
1203 if (Property) {
1204 Diag(NameLoc, diag::warn_ivar_variable_conflict) << Var->getDeclName();
1205 Diag(Property->getLocation(), diag::note_property_declare);
Fariborz Jahanianf759b4d2010-08-13 18:09:39 +00001206 Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_global_declared_at);
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001207 }
1208 }
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001209 } else if (FunctionDecl *Func = R.getAsSingle<FunctionDecl>()) {
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001210 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && !Func->hasPrototype()) {
1211 // C99 DR 316 says that, if a function type comes from a
1212 // function definition (without a prototype), that type is only
1213 // used for checking compatibility. Therefore, when referencing
1214 // the function, we pretend that we don't have the full function
1215 // type.
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001216 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Func, NameLoc))
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001217 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001218
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001219 QualType T = Func->getType();
1220 QualType NoProtoType = T;
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001221 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
Eli Friedman9a0fcfe2010-05-17 02:50:18 +00001222 NoProtoType = Context.getFunctionNoProtoType(Proto->getResultType(),
1223 Proto->getExtInfo());
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001224 return BuildDeclRefExpr(Func, NoProtoType, NameLoc, &SS);
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001225 }
1226 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001227
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001228 // Check whether this might be a C++ implicit instance member access.
John McCallfb97e752010-08-24 22:52:39 +00001229 // C++ [class.mfct.non-static]p3:
1230 // When an id-expression that is not part of a class member access
1231 // syntax and not used to form a pointer to member is used in the
1232 // body of a non-static member function of class X, if name lookup
1233 // resolves the name in the id-expression to a non-static non-type
1234 // member of some class C, the id-expression is transformed into a
1235 // class member access expression using (*this) as the
1236 // postfix-expression to the left of the . operator.
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00001237 //
1238 // But we don't actually need to do this for '&' operands if R
1239 // resolved to a function or overloaded function set, because the
1240 // expression is ill-formed if it actually works out to be a
1241 // non-static member function:
1242 //
1243 // C++ [expr.ref]p4:
1244 // Otherwise, if E1.E2 refers to a non-static member function. . .
1245 // [t]he expression can be used only as the left-hand operand of a
1246 // member function call.
1247 //
1248 // There are other safeguards against such uses, but it's important
1249 // to get this right here so that we don't end up making a
1250 // spuriously dependent expression if we're inside a dependent
1251 // instance method.
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001252 if (!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember()) {
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00001253 bool MightBeImplicitMember;
1254 if (!isAddressOfOperand)
1255 MightBeImplicitMember = true;
1256 else if (!SS.isEmpty())
1257 MightBeImplicitMember = false;
1258 else if (R.isOverloadedResult())
1259 MightBeImplicitMember = false;
Douglas Gregore2248be2010-08-30 16:00:47 +00001260 else if (R.isUnresolvableResult())
1261 MightBeImplicitMember = true;
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00001262 else
1263 MightBeImplicitMember = isa<FieldDecl>(R.getFoundDecl());
1264
1265 if (MightBeImplicitMember)
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001266 return BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001267 }
1268
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001269 if (TemplateArgs)
1270 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, ADL, *TemplateArgs);
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001271
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001272 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, ADL);
1273}
1274
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001275/// Builds an expression which might be an implicit member expression.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001276ExprResult
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001277Sema::BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1278 LookupResult &R,
1279 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
1280 switch (ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(*this, R)) {
1281 case IMA_Instance:
1282 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, true);
1283
1284 case IMA_AnonymousMember:
1285 assert(R.isSingleResult());
1286 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(R.getNameLoc(),
1287 R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>());
1288
1289 case IMA_Mixed:
1290 case IMA_Mixed_Unrelated:
1291 case IMA_Unresolved:
1292 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, false);
1293
1294 case IMA_Static:
1295 case IMA_Mixed_StaticContext:
1296 case IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext:
1297 if (TemplateArgs)
1298 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, false, *TemplateArgs);
1299 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, false);
1300
1301 case IMA_Error_StaticContext:
1302 case IMA_Error_Unrelated:
1303 DiagnoseInstanceReference(*this, SS, R);
1304 return ExprError();
1305 }
1306
1307 llvm_unreachable("unexpected instance member access kind");
1308 return ExprError();
1309}
1310
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001311/// BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr - Build a C++ qualified
1312/// declaration name, generally during template instantiation.
1313/// There's a large number of things which don't need to be done along
1314/// this path.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001315ExprResult
Jeffrey Yasskin9ab14542010-04-08 16:38:48 +00001316Sema::BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr(CXXScopeSpec &SS,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001317 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001318 DeclContext *DC;
Douglas Gregore6ec5c42010-04-28 07:04:26 +00001319 if (!(DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false)) || DC->isDependentContext())
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001320 return BuildDependentDeclRefExpr(SS, NameInfo, 0);
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001321
John McCall77bb1aa2010-05-01 00:40:08 +00001322 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC))
Douglas Gregore6ec5c42010-04-28 07:04:26 +00001323 return ExprError();
1324
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001325 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupOrdinaryName);
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001326 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
1327
1328 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1329 return ExprError();
1330
1331 if (R.empty()) {
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001332 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
1333 << NameInfo.getName() << DC << SS.getRange();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001334 return ExprError();
1335 }
1336
1337 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, /*ADL*/ false);
1338}
1339
1340/// LookupInObjCMethod - The parser has read a name in, and Sema has
1341/// detected that we're currently inside an ObjC method. Perform some
1342/// additional lookup.
1343///
1344/// Ideally, most of this would be done by lookup, but there's
1345/// actually quite a lot of extra work involved.
1346///
1347/// Returns a null sentinel to indicate trivial success.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001348ExprResult
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001349Sema::LookupInObjCMethod(LookupResult &Lookup, Scope *S,
Chris Lattnereb483eb2010-04-11 08:28:14 +00001350 IdentifierInfo *II, bool AllowBuiltinCreation) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001351 SourceLocation Loc = Lookup.getNameLoc();
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001352 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMethod = getCurMethodDecl();
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001353
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001354 // There are two cases to handle here. 1) scoped lookup could have failed,
1355 // in which case we should look for an ivar. 2) scoped lookup could have
1356 // found a decl, but that decl is outside the current instance method (i.e.
1357 // a global variable). In these two cases, we do a lookup for an ivar with
1358 // this name, if the lookup sucedes, we replace it our current decl.
1359
1360 // If we're in a class method, we don't normally want to look for
1361 // ivars. But if we don't find anything else, and there's an
1362 // ivar, that's an error.
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001363 bool IsClassMethod = CurMethod->isClassMethod();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001364
1365 bool LookForIvars;
1366 if (Lookup.empty())
1367 LookForIvars = true;
1368 else if (IsClassMethod)
1369 LookForIvars = false;
1370 else
1371 LookForIvars = (Lookup.isSingleResult() &&
1372 Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod());
Fariborz Jahanian412e7982010-02-09 19:31:38 +00001373 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = 0;
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001374 if (LookForIvars) {
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001375 IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001376 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1377 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1378 // Diagnose using an ivar in a class method.
1379 if (IsClassMethod)
1380 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::error_ivar_use_in_class_method)
1381 << IV->getDeclName());
1382
1383 // If we're referencing an invalid decl, just return this as a silent
1384 // error node. The error diagnostic was already emitted on the decl.
1385 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
1386 return ExprError();
1387
1388 // Check if referencing a field with __attribute__((deprecated)).
1389 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, Loc))
1390 return ExprError();
1391
1392 // Diagnose the use of an ivar outside of the declaring class.
1393 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private &&
1394 ClassDeclared != IFace)
1395 Diag(Loc, diag::error_private_ivar_access) << IV->getDeclName();
1396
1397 // FIXME: This should use a new expr for a direct reference, don't
1398 // turn this into Self->ivar, just return a BareIVarExpr or something.
1399 IdentifierInfo &II = Context.Idents.get("self");
1400 UnqualifiedId SelfName;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001401 SelfName.setIdentifier(&II, SourceLocation());
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001402 CXXScopeSpec SelfScopeSpec;
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001403 ExprResult SelfExpr = ActOnIdExpression(S, SelfScopeSpec,
Douglas Gregore45bb6a2010-09-22 16:33:13 +00001404 SelfName, false, false);
1405 if (SelfExpr.isInvalid())
1406 return ExprError();
1407
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001408 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, IV);
1409 return Owned(new (Context)
1410 ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(), Loc,
1411 SelfExpr.takeAs<Expr>(), true, true));
1412 }
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001413 } else if (CurMethod->isInstanceMethod()) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001414 // We should warn if a local variable hides an ivar.
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001415 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001416 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1417 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1418 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Private ||
1419 IFace == ClassDeclared)
1420 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_ivar_use_hidden) << IV->getDeclName();
1421 }
1422 }
1423
Fariborz Jahanian48c2d562010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001424 if (Lookup.empty() && II && AllowBuiltinCreation) {
1425 // FIXME. Consolidate this with similar code in LookupName.
1426 if (unsigned BuiltinID = II->getBuiltinID()) {
1427 if (!(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
1428 Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(BuiltinID))) {
1429 NamedDecl *D = LazilyCreateBuiltin((IdentifierInfo *)II, BuiltinID,
1430 S, Lookup.isForRedeclaration(),
1431 Lookup.getNameLoc());
1432 if (D) Lookup.addDecl(D);
1433 }
1434 }
1435 }
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001436 // Sentinel value saying that we didn't do anything special.
1437 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001438}
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001439
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001440/// \brief Cast a base object to a member's actual type.
1441///
1442/// Logically this happens in three phases:
1443///
1444/// * First we cast from the base type to the naming class.
1445/// The naming class is the class into which we were looking
1446/// when we found the member; it's the qualifier type if a
1447/// qualifier was provided, and otherwise it's the base type.
1448///
1449/// * Next we cast from the naming class to the declaring class.
1450/// If the member we found was brought into a class's scope by
1451/// a using declaration, this is that class; otherwise it's
1452/// the class declaring the member.
1453///
1454/// * Finally we cast from the declaring class to the "true"
1455/// declaring class of the member. This conversion does not
1456/// obey access control.
Fariborz Jahanianf3e53d32009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001457bool
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001458Sema::PerformObjectMemberConversion(Expr *&From,
1459 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001460 NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001461 NamedDecl *Member) {
1462 CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Member->getDeclContext());
1463 if (!RD)
1464 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001465
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001466 QualType DestRecordType;
1467 QualType DestType;
1468 QualType FromRecordType;
1469 QualType FromType = From->getType();
1470 bool PointerConversions = false;
1471 if (isa<FieldDecl>(Member)) {
1472 DestRecordType = Context.getCanonicalType(Context.getTypeDeclType(RD));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001473
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001474 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1475 DestType = Context.getPointerType(DestRecordType);
1476 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1477 PointerConversions = true;
1478 } else {
1479 DestType = DestRecordType;
1480 FromRecordType = FromType;
Fariborz Jahanian98a541e2009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001481 }
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001482 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Member)) {
1483 if (Method->isStatic())
1484 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001485
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001486 DestType = Method->getThisType(Context);
1487 DestRecordType = DestType->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001488
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001489 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1490 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1491 PointerConversions = true;
1492 } else {
1493 FromRecordType = FromType;
1494 DestType = DestRecordType;
1495 }
1496 } else {
1497 // No conversion necessary.
1498 return false;
1499 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001500
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001501 if (DestType->isDependentType() || FromType->isDependentType())
1502 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001503
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001504 // If the unqualified types are the same, no conversion is necessary.
1505 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1506 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001507
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001508 SourceRange FromRange = From->getSourceRange();
1509 SourceLocation FromLoc = FromRange.getBegin();
1510
John McCall5baba9d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001511 ExprValueKind VK = CastCategory(From);
Sebastian Redl906082e2010-07-20 04:20:21 +00001512
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001513 // C++ [class.member.lookup]p8:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001514 // [...] Ambiguities can often be resolved by qualifying a name with its
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001515 // class name.
1516 //
1517 // If the member was a qualified name and the qualified referred to a
1518 // specific base subobject type, we'll cast to that intermediate type
1519 // first and then to the object in which the member is declared. That allows
1520 // one to resolve ambiguities in, e.g., a diamond-shaped hierarchy such as:
1521 //
1522 // class Base { public: int x; };
1523 // class Derived1 : public Base { };
1524 // class Derived2 : public Base { };
1525 // class VeryDerived : public Derived1, public Derived2 { void f(); };
1526 //
1527 // void VeryDerived::f() {
1528 // x = 17; // error: ambiguous base subobjects
1529 // Derived1::x = 17; // okay, pick the Base subobject of Derived1
1530 // }
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001531 if (Qualifier) {
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001532 QualType QType = QualType(Qualifier->getAsType(), 0);
1533 assert(!QType.isNull() && "lookup done with dependent qualifier?");
1534 assert(QType->isRecordType() && "lookup done with non-record type");
1535
1536 QualType QRecordType = QualType(QType->getAs<RecordType>(), 0);
1537
1538 // In C++98, the qualifier type doesn't actually have to be a base
1539 // type of the object type, in which case we just ignore it.
1540 // Otherwise build the appropriate casts.
1541 if (IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, QRecordType)) {
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001542 CXXCastPath BasePath;
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001543 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, QRecordType,
Anders Carlssoncee22422010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001544 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001545 return true;
1546
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001547 if (PointerConversions)
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001548 QType = Context.getPointerType(QType);
John McCall5baba9d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001549 ImpCastExprToType(From, QType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
1550 VK, &BasePath);
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001551
1552 FromType = QType;
1553 FromRecordType = QRecordType;
1554
1555 // If the qualifier type was the same as the destination type,
1556 // we're done.
1557 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1558 return false;
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001559 }
1560 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001561
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001562 bool IgnoreAccess = false;
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001563
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001564 // If we actually found the member through a using declaration, cast
1565 // down to the using declaration's type.
1566 //
1567 // Pointer equality is fine here because only one declaration of a
1568 // class ever has member declarations.
1569 if (FoundDecl->getDeclContext() != Member->getDeclContext()) {
1570 assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(FoundDecl));
1571 QualType URecordType = Context.getTypeDeclType(
1572 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FoundDecl->getDeclContext()));
1573
1574 // We only need to do this if the naming-class to declaring-class
1575 // conversion is non-trivial.
1576 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, URecordType)) {
1577 assert(IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, URecordType));
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001578 CXXCastPath BasePath;
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001579 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, URecordType,
Anders Carlssoncee22422010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001580 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001581 return true;
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001582
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001583 QualType UType = URecordType;
1584 if (PointerConversions)
1585 UType = Context.getPointerType(UType);
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00001586 ImpCastExprToType(From, UType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
John McCall5baba9d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001587 VK, &BasePath);
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001588 FromType = UType;
1589 FromRecordType = URecordType;
1590 }
1591
1592 // We don't do access control for the conversion from the
1593 // declaring class to the true declaring class.
1594 IgnoreAccess = true;
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001595 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001596
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001597 CXXCastPath BasePath;
Anders Carlssoncee22422010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001598 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, DestRecordType,
1599 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001600 IgnoreAccess))
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001601 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001602
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00001603 ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
John McCall5baba9d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001604 VK, &BasePath);
Fariborz Jahanianf3e53d32009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001605 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian98a541e2009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001606}
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001607
Douglas Gregor83f6faf2009-08-31 23:41:50 +00001608/// \brief Build a MemberExpr AST node.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001609static MemberExpr *BuildMemberExpr(ASTContext &C, Expr *Base, bool isArrow,
Eli Friedmanf595cc42009-12-04 06:40:45 +00001610 const CXXScopeSpec &SS, ValueDecl *Member,
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00001611 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001612 const DeclarationNameInfo &MemberNameInfo,
1613 QualType Ty,
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001614 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs = 0) {
1615 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = 0;
1616 SourceRange QualifierRange;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001617 if (SS.isSet()) {
1618 Qualifier = (NestedNameSpecifier *) SS.getScopeRep();
1619 QualifierRange = SS.getRange();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001620 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001621
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001622 return MemberExpr::Create(C, Base, isArrow, Qualifier, QualifierRange,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001623 Member, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
1624 TemplateArgs, Ty);
Douglas Gregorbd4c4ae2009-08-26 22:36:53 +00001625}
1626
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001627/// Builds an implicit member access expression. The current context
1628/// is known to be an instance method, and the given unqualified lookup
1629/// set is known to contain only instance members, at least one of which
1630/// is from an appropriate type.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001631ExprResult
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001632Sema::BuildImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1633 LookupResult &R,
1634 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
1635 bool IsKnownInstance) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001636 assert(!R.empty() && !R.isAmbiguous());
1637
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001638 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00001639
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001640 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
1641 // (C++ [class.union]).
Douglas Gregore961afb2009-10-22 07:08:30 +00001642 // FIXME: This needs to happen post-isImplicitMemberReference?
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001643 // FIXME: template-ids inside anonymous structs?
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001644 if (FieldDecl *FD = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>())
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001645 if (cast<RecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001646 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(Loc, FD);
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001647
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001648 // If this is known to be an instance access, go ahead and build a
1649 // 'this' expression now.
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001650 DeclContext *DC = getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
1651 QualType ThisType = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->getThisType(Context);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001652 Expr *This = 0; // null signifies implicit access
1653 if (IsKnownInstance) {
Douglas Gregor828a1972010-01-07 23:12:05 +00001654 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
1655 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
1656 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
1657 This = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, ThisType, /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00001658 }
1659
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00001660 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(This, ThisType,
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001661 /*OpLoc*/ SourceLocation(),
1662 /*IsArrow*/ true,
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00001663 SS,
1664 /*FirstQualifierInScope*/ 0,
1665 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001666}
1667
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001668bool Sema::UseArgumentDependentLookup(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001669 const LookupResult &R,
1670 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001671 // Only when used directly as the postfix-expression of a call.
1672 if (!HasTrailingLParen)
1673 return false;
1674
1675 // Never if a scope specifier was provided.
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001676 if (SS.isSet())
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001677 return false;
1678
1679 // Only in C++ or ObjC++.
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001680 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001681 return false;
1682
1683 // Turn off ADL when we find certain kinds of declarations during
1684 // normal lookup:
1685 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
1686 NamedDecl *D = *I;
1687
1688 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1689 // -- a declaration of a class member
1690 // Since using decls preserve this property, we check this on the
1691 // original decl.
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001692 if (D->isCXXClassMember())
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001693 return false;
1694
1695 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1696 // -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a
1697 // using-declaration
1698 // NOTE: we also trigger this for function templates (in fact, we
1699 // don't check the decl type at all, since all other decl types
1700 // turn off ADL anyway).
1701 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
1702 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
1703 else if (D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())
1704 return false;
1705
1706 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1707 // -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function
1708 // template
1709 // And also for builtin functions.
1710 if (isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
1711 FunctionDecl *FDecl = cast<FunctionDecl>(D);
1712
1713 // But also builtin functions.
1714 if (FDecl->getBuiltinID() && FDecl->isImplicit())
1715 return false;
1716 } else if (!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
1717 return false;
1718 }
1719
1720 return true;
1721}
1722
1723
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001724/// Diagnoses obvious problems with the use of the given declaration
1725/// as an expression. This is only actually called for lookups that
1726/// were not overloaded, and it doesn't promise that the declaration
1727/// will in fact be used.
1728static bool CheckDeclInExpr(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, NamedDecl *D) {
1729 if (isa<TypedefDecl>(D)) {
1730 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_typedef) << D->getDeclName();
1731 return true;
1732 }
1733
1734 if (isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D)) {
1735 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_interface) << D->getDeclName();
1736 return true;
1737 }
1738
1739 if (isa<NamespaceDecl>(D)) {
1740 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_namespace) << D->getDeclName();
1741 return true;
1742 }
1743
1744 return false;
1745}
1746
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001747ExprResult
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001748Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001749 LookupResult &R,
1750 bool NeedsADL) {
John McCallfead20c2009-12-08 22:45:53 +00001751 // If this is a single, fully-resolved result and we don't need ADL,
1752 // just build an ordinary singleton decl ref.
Douglas Gregor86b8e092010-01-29 17:15:43 +00001753 if (!NeedsADL && R.isSingleResult() && !R.getAsSingle<FunctionTemplateDecl>())
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001754 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getLookupNameInfo(),
1755 R.getFoundDecl());
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001756
1757 // We only need to check the declaration if there's exactly one
1758 // result, because in the overloaded case the results can only be
1759 // functions and function templates.
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001760 if (R.isSingleResult() &&
1761 CheckDeclInExpr(*this, R.getNameLoc(), R.getFoundDecl()))
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001762 return ExprError();
1763
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001764 // Otherwise, just build an unresolved lookup expression. Suppress
1765 // any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll hash these out later, when
1766 // we've picked a target.
1767 R.suppressDiagnostics();
1768
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001769 bool Dependent
1770 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::ComputeDependence(R.begin(), R.end(), 0);
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001771 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001772 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, Dependent, R.getNamingClass(),
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001773 (NestedNameSpecifier*) SS.getScopeRep(),
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001774 SS.getRange(), R.getLookupNameInfo(),
Douglas Gregor5a84dec2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00001775 NeedsADL, R.isOverloadedResult(),
1776 R.begin(), R.end());
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001777
1778 return Owned(ULE);
1779}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001780
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001781
1782/// \brief Complete semantic analysis for a reference to the given declaration.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001783ExprResult
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001784Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001785 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
1786 NamedDecl *D) {
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001787 assert(D && "Cannot refer to a NULL declaration");
John McCall7453ed42009-11-22 00:44:51 +00001788 assert(!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D) &&
1789 "Cannot refer unambiguously to a function template");
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001790
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001791 SourceLocation Loc = NameInfo.getLoc();
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001792 if (CheckDeclInExpr(*this, Loc, D))
1793 return ExprError();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001794
Douglas Gregor9af2f522009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001795 if (TemplateDecl *Template = dyn_cast<TemplateDecl>(D)) {
1796 // Specifically diagnose references to class templates that are missing
1797 // a template argument list.
1798 Diag(Loc, diag::err_template_decl_ref)
1799 << Template << SS.getRange();
1800 Diag(Template->getLocation(), diag::note_template_decl_here);
1801 return ExprError();
1802 }
1803
1804 // Make sure that we're referring to a value.
1805 ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(D);
1806 if (!VD) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001807 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_non_value)
Douglas Gregor9af2f522009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001808 << D << SS.getRange();
John McCall87cf6702009-12-18 18:35:10 +00001809 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
Douglas Gregor9af2f522009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001810 return ExprError();
1811 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001812
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001813 // Check whether this declaration can be used. Note that we suppress
1814 // this check when we're going to perform argument-dependent lookup
1815 // on this function name, because this might not be the function
1816 // that overload resolution actually selects.
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001817 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(VD, Loc))
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001818 return ExprError();
1819
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00001820 // Only create DeclRefExpr's for valid Decl's.
1821 if (VD->isInvalidDecl())
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001822 return ExprError();
1823
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +00001824 // If the identifier reference is inside a block, and it refers to a value
1825 // that is outside the block, create a BlockDeclRefExpr instead of a
1826 // DeclRefExpr. This ensures the value is treated as a copy-in snapshot when
1827 // the block is formed.
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00001828 //
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +00001829 // We do not do this for things like enum constants, global variables, etc,
1830 // as they do not get snapshotted.
1831 //
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001832 if (getCurBlock() &&
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00001833 ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(*this, getCurBlock(), VD)) {
Mike Stump0d6fd572010-01-05 02:56:35 +00001834 if (VD->getType().getTypePtr()->isVariablyModifiedType()) {
1835 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_vm_type);
1836 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
1837 return ExprError();
1838 }
1839
Fariborz Jahanian8596bbe2010-03-16 23:39:51 +00001840 if (VD->getType()->isArrayType()) {
Mike Stump28497342010-01-05 03:10:36 +00001841 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_array_type);
1842 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
1843 return ExprError();
1844 }
1845
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00001846 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, VD);
Eli Friedman5fdeae12009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001847 QualType ExprTy = VD->getType().getNonReferenceType();
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001848 // The BlocksAttr indicates the variable is bound by-reference.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40b598e2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00001849 if (VD->getAttr<BlocksAttr>())
Eli Friedman5fdeae12009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001850 return Owned(new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD, ExprTy, Loc, true));
Fariborz Jahanian7d5c74e2009-06-19 23:37:08 +00001851 // This is to record that a 'const' was actually synthesize and added.
1852 bool constAdded = !ExprTy.isConstQualified();
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001853 // Variable will be bound by-copy, make it const within the closure.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001854
Eli Friedman5fdeae12009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001855 ExprTy.addConst();
Fariborz Jahanian52bc56a2010-07-12 17:26:57 +00001856 QualType T = VD->getType();
Fariborz Jahanian59da45a2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001857 BlockDeclRefExpr *BDRE = new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD,
1858 ExprTy, Loc, false,
Fariborz Jahanian84ca0082010-07-12 18:12:03 +00001859 constAdded);
Fariborz Jahanian833f42e2010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001860 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
1861 if (!T->isDependentType() && !T->isReferenceType()) {
1862 Expr *E = new (Context)
1863 DeclRefExpr(const_cast<ValueDecl*>(BDRE->getDecl()), T,
1864 SourceLocation());
Fariborz Jahanian59da45a2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001865
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001866 ExprResult Res = PerformCopyInitialization(
Fariborz Jahanian833f42e2010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001867 InitializedEntity::InitializeBlock(VD->getLocation(),
Fariborz Jahanian310b1c42010-06-07 16:14:00 +00001868 T, false),
Fariborz Jahanian833f42e2010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001869 SourceLocation(),
1870 Owned(E));
1871 if (!Res.isInvalid()) {
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00001872 Res = MaybeCreateCXXExprWithTemporaries(Res.get());
Fariborz Jahanian833f42e2010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001873 Expr *Init = Res.takeAs<Expr>();
1874 BDRE->setCopyConstructorExpr(Init);
1875 }
Fariborz Jahanian59da45a2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001876 }
1877 }
1878 return Owned(BDRE);
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001879 }
1880 // If this reference is not in a block or if the referenced variable is
1881 // within the block, create a normal DeclRefExpr.
Douglas Gregor898574e2008-12-05 23:32:09 +00001882
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001883 return BuildDeclRefExpr(VD, VD->getType().getNonReferenceType(),
1884 NameInfo, &SS);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001885}
1886
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001887ExprResult Sema::ActOnPredefinedExpr(SourceLocation Loc,
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001888 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
Chris Lattnerd9f69102008-08-10 01:53:14 +00001889 PredefinedExpr::IdentType IT;
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001890
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001891 switch (Kind) {
Chris Lattner1423ea42008-01-12 18:39:25 +00001892 default: assert(0 && "Unknown simple primary expr!");
Chris Lattnerd9f69102008-08-10 01:53:14 +00001893 case tok::kw___func__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Func; break; // [C99 6.4.2.2]
1894 case tok::kw___FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Function; break;
1895 case tok::kw___PRETTY_FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::PrettyFunction; break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001896 }
Chris Lattner1423ea42008-01-12 18:39:25 +00001897
Chris Lattnerfa28b302008-01-12 08:14:25 +00001898 // Pre-defined identifiers are of type char[x], where x is the length of the
1899 // string.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001900
Anders Carlsson3a082d82009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001901 Decl *currentDecl = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl();
Fariborz Jahanianeb024ac2010-07-23 21:53:24 +00001902 if (!currentDecl && getCurBlock())
1903 currentDecl = getCurBlock()->TheDecl;
Anders Carlsson3a082d82009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001904 if (!currentDecl) {
Chris Lattnerb0da9232008-12-12 05:05:20 +00001905 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_predef_outside_function);
Anders Carlsson3a082d82009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001906 currentDecl = Context.getTranslationUnitDecl();
Chris Lattnerb0da9232008-12-12 05:05:20 +00001907 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001908
Anders Carlsson773f3972009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001909 QualType ResTy;
1910 if (cast<DeclContext>(currentDecl)->isDependentContext()) {
1911 ResTy = Context.DependentTy;
1912 } else {
Anders Carlsson848fa642010-02-11 18:20:28 +00001913 unsigned Length = PredefinedExpr::ComputeName(IT, currentDecl).length();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001914
Anders Carlsson773f3972009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001915 llvm::APInt LengthI(32, Length + 1);
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001916 ResTy = Context.CharTy.withConst();
Anders Carlsson773f3972009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001917 ResTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(ResTy, LengthI, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
1918 }
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00001919 return Owned(new (Context) PredefinedExpr(Loc, ResTy, IT));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001920}
1921
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001922ExprResult Sema::ActOnCharacterConstant(const Token &Tok) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001923 llvm::SmallString<16> CharBuffer;
Douglas Gregor453091c2010-03-16 22:30:13 +00001924 bool Invalid = false;
1925 llvm::StringRef ThisTok = PP.getSpelling(Tok, CharBuffer, &Invalid);
1926 if (Invalid)
1927 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001928
Benjamin Kramerddeea562010-02-27 13:44:12 +00001929 CharLiteralParser Literal(ThisTok.begin(), ThisTok.end(), Tok.getLocation(),
1930 PP);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001931 if (Literal.hadError())
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001932 return ExprError();
Chris Lattnerfc62bfd2008-03-01 08:32:21 +00001933
Chris Lattnere8337df2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001934 QualType Ty;
1935 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
1936 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'x' and L'x' -> int in C.
1937 else if (Literal.isWide())
1938 Ty = Context.WCharTy; // L'x' -> wchar_t in C++.
Eli Friedman136b0cd2010-02-03 18:21:45 +00001939 else if (Literal.isMultiChar())
1940 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'wxyz' -> int in C++.
Chris Lattnere8337df2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001941 else
1942 Ty = Context.CharTy; // 'x' -> char in C++
Chris Lattnerfc62bfd2008-03-01 08:32:21 +00001943
Sebastian Redle91b3bc2009-01-20 22:23:13 +00001944 return Owned(new (Context) CharacterLiteral(Literal.getValue(),
1945 Literal.isWide(),
Chris Lattnere8337df2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001946 Ty, Tok.getLocation()));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001947}
1948
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001949ExprResult Sema::ActOnNumericConstant(const Token &Tok) {
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001950 // Fast path for a single digit (which is quite common). A single digit
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001951 // cannot have a trigraph, escaped newline, radix prefix, or type suffix.
1952 if (Tok.getLength() == 1) {
Chris Lattner7216dc92009-01-26 22:36:52 +00001953 const char Val = PP.getSpellingOfSingleCharacterNumericConstant(Tok);
Chris Lattner0c21e842009-01-16 07:10:29 +00001954 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9996a7f2010-08-28 09:06:06 +00001955 return Owned(IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, llvm::APInt(IntSize, Val-'0'),
Steve Naroff0a473932009-01-20 19:53:53 +00001956 Context.IntTy, Tok.getLocation()));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001957 }
Ted Kremenek28396602009-01-13 23:19:12 +00001958
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001959 llvm::SmallString<512> IntegerBuffer;
Chris Lattner2a299042008-09-30 20:53:45 +00001960 // Add padding so that NumericLiteralParser can overread by one character.
1961 IntegerBuffer.resize(Tok.getLength()+1);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001962 const char *ThisTokBegin = &IntegerBuffer[0];
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001963
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001964 // Get the spelling of the token, which eliminates trigraphs, etc.
Douglas Gregor453091c2010-03-16 22:30:13 +00001965 bool Invalid = false;
1966 unsigned ActualLength = PP.getSpelling(Tok, ThisTokBegin, &Invalid);
1967 if (Invalid)
1968 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001969
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001970 NumericLiteralParser Literal(ThisTokBegin, ThisTokBegin+ActualLength,
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001971 Tok.getLocation(), PP);
1972 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001973 return ExprError();
1974
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001975 Expr *Res;
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001976
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001977 if (Literal.isFloatingLiteral()) {
Chris Lattner525a0502007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001978 QualType Ty;
Chris Lattnerb7cfe882008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001979 if (Literal.isFloat)
Chris Lattner525a0502007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001980 Ty = Context.FloatTy;
Chris Lattnerb7cfe882008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001981 else if (!Literal.isLong)
Chris Lattner525a0502007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001982 Ty = Context.DoubleTy;
Chris Lattnerb7cfe882008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001983 else
Chris Lattner9e9b6dc2008-03-08 08:52:55 +00001984 Ty = Context.LongDoubleTy;
Chris Lattnerb7cfe882008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001985
1986 const llvm::fltSemantics &Format = Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(Ty);
1987
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001988 using llvm::APFloat;
1989 APFloat Val(Format);
1990
1991 APFloat::opStatus result = Literal.GetFloatValue(Val);
John McCall9f2df882009-12-24 11:09:08 +00001992
1993 // Overflow is always an error, but underflow is only an error if
1994 // we underflowed to zero (APFloat reports denormals as underflow).
1995 if ((result & APFloat::opOverflow) ||
1996 ((result & APFloat::opUnderflow) && Val.isZero())) {
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001997 unsigned diagnostic;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001998 llvm::SmallString<20> buffer;
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001999 if (result & APFloat::opOverflow) {
John McCall2a0d7572010-02-26 23:35:57 +00002000 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_overflow;
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002001 APFloat::getLargest(Format).toString(buffer);
2002 } else {
John McCall2a0d7572010-02-26 23:35:57 +00002003 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_underflow;
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002004 APFloat::getSmallest(Format).toString(buffer);
2005 }
2006
2007 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diagnostic)
2008 << Ty
2009 << llvm::StringRef(buffer.data(), buffer.size());
2010 }
2011
2012 bool isExact = (result == APFloat::opOK);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9996a7f2010-08-28 09:06:06 +00002013 Res = FloatingLiteral::Create(Context, Val, isExact, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002014
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002015 } else if (!Literal.isIntegerLiteral()) {
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002016 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002017 } else {
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002018 QualType Ty;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002019
Neil Boothb9449512007-08-29 22:00:19 +00002020 // long long is a C99 feature.
2021 if (!getLangOptions().C99 && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus0x &&
Neil Booth79859c32007-08-29 22:13:52 +00002022 Literal.isLongLong)
Neil Boothb9449512007-08-29 22:00:19 +00002023 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::ext_longlong);
2024
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002025 // Get the value in the widest-possible width.
Chris Lattner98be4942008-03-05 18:54:05 +00002026 llvm::APInt ResultVal(Context.Target.getIntMaxTWidth(), 0);
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002027
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002028 if (Literal.GetIntegerValue(ResultVal)) {
2029 // If this value didn't fit into uintmax_t, warn and force to ull.
2030 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large);
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002031 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
2032 assert(Context.getTypeSize(Ty) == ResultVal.getBitWidth() &&
Chris Lattner98be4942008-03-05 18:54:05 +00002033 "long long is not intmax_t?");
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002034 } else {
2035 // If this value fits into a ULL, try to figure out what else it fits into
2036 // according to the rules of C99 6.4.4.1p5.
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002037
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002038 // Octal, Hexadecimal, and integers with a U suffix are allowed to
2039 // be an unsigned int.
2040 bool AllowUnsigned = Literal.isUnsigned || Literal.getRadix() != 10;
2041
2042 // Check from smallest to largest, picking the smallest type we can.
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002043 unsigned Width = 0;
Chris Lattner97c51562007-08-23 21:58:08 +00002044 if (!Literal.isLong && !Literal.isLongLong) {
2045 // Are int/unsigned possibilities?
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002046 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002047
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002048 // Does it fit in a unsigned int?
2049 if (ResultVal.isIntN(IntSize)) {
2050 // Does it fit in a signed int?
2051 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[IntSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002052 Ty = Context.IntTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002053 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002054 Ty = Context.UnsignedIntTy;
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002055 Width = IntSize;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002056 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002057 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002058
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002059 // Are long/unsigned long possibilities?
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002060 if (Ty.isNull() && !Literal.isLongLong) {
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002061 unsigned LongSize = Context.Target.getLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002062
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002063 // Does it fit in a unsigned long?
2064 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongSize)) {
2065 // Does it fit in a signed long?
2066 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002067 Ty = Context.LongTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002068 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002069 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongTy;
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002070 Width = LongSize;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002071 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002072 }
2073
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002074 // Finally, check long long if needed.
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002075 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002076 unsigned LongLongSize = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002077
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002078 // Does it fit in a unsigned long long?
2079 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongLongSize)) {
2080 // Does it fit in a signed long long?
2081 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongLongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002082 Ty = Context.LongLongTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002083 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002084 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002085 Width = LongLongSize;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002086 }
2087 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002088
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002089 // If we still couldn't decide a type, we probably have something that
2090 // does not fit in a signed long long, but has no U suffix.
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002091 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002092 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large_for_signed);
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002093 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002094 Width = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002095 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002096
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002097 if (ResultVal.getBitWidth() != Width)
2098 ResultVal.trunc(Width);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002099 }
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9996a7f2010-08-28 09:06:06 +00002100 Res = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, ResultVal, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002101 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002102
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002103 // If this is an imaginary literal, create the ImaginaryLiteral wrapper.
2104 if (Literal.isImaginary)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002105 Res = new (Context) ImaginaryLiteral(Res,
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002106 Context.getComplexType(Res->getType()));
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002107
2108 return Owned(Res);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002109}
2110
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002111ExprResult Sema::ActOnParenExpr(SourceLocation L,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002112 SourceLocation R, Expr *E) {
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002113 assert((E != 0) && "ActOnParenExpr() missing expr");
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002114 return Owned(new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, E));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002115}
2116
2117/// The UsualUnaryConversions() function is *not* called by this routine.
2118/// See C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4] for more details.
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002119bool Sema::CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(QualType exprType,
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002120 SourceLocation OpLoc,
2121 const SourceRange &ExprRange,
2122 bool isSizeof) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002123 if (exprType->isDependentType())
2124 return false;
2125
Sebastian Redl5d484e82009-11-23 17:18:46 +00002126 // C++ [expr.sizeof]p2: "When applied to a reference or a reference type,
2127 // the result is the size of the referenced type."
2128 // C++ [expr.alignof]p3: "When alignof is applied to a reference type, the
2129 // result shall be the alignment of the referenced type."
2130 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = exprType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
2131 exprType = Ref->getPointeeType();
2132
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002133 // C99 6.5.3.4p1:
John McCall5ab75172009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002134 if (exprType->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002135 // alignof(function) is allowed as an extension.
Chris Lattner01072922009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002136 if (isSizeof)
2137 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_function_type) << ExprRange;
2138 return false;
2139 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002140
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002141 // Allow sizeof(void)/alignof(void) as an extension.
Chris Lattner01072922009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002142 if (exprType->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00002143 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_void_type)
2144 << (isSizeof ? "sizeof" : "__alignof") << ExprRange;
Chris Lattner01072922009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002145 return false;
2146 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002147
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002148 if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, exprType,
Douglas Gregor5cc07df2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00002149 PDiag(diag::err_sizeof_alignof_incomplete_type)
2150 << int(!isSizeof) << ExprRange))
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002151 return true;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002152
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002153 // Reject sizeof(interface) and sizeof(interface<proto>) in 64-bit mode.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002154 if (LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI && exprType->isObjCObjectType()) {
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002155 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_nonfragile_interface)
Chris Lattner5cb10d32009-04-24 22:30:50 +00002156 << exprType << isSizeof << ExprRange;
2157 return true;
Chris Lattnerca790922009-04-21 19:55:16 +00002158 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002159
Douglas Gregor9ba6af82010-05-23 19:43:23 +00002160 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(exprType, Context.OverloadTy)) {
2161 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_overloaded_function_type)
2162 << !isSizeof << ExprRange;
2163 return true;
2164 }
2165
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002166 return false;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002167}
2168
Chris Lattner31e21e02009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002169bool Sema::CheckAlignOfExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
2170 const SourceRange &ExprRange) {
2171 E = E->IgnoreParens();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002172
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002173 // alignof decl is always ok.
Chris Lattner31e21e02009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002174 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(E))
2175 return false;
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002176
2177 // Cannot know anything else if the expression is dependent.
2178 if (E->isTypeDependent())
2179 return false;
2180
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002181 if (E->getBitField()) {
2182 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 1 << ExprRange;
2183 return true;
Chris Lattner31e21e02009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002184 }
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002185
2186 // Alignment of a field access is always okay, so long as it isn't a
2187 // bit-field.
2188 if (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E))
Mike Stump8e1fab22009-07-22 18:58:19 +00002189 if (isa<FieldDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl()))
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002190 return false;
2191
Chris Lattner31e21e02009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002192 return CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, ExprRange, false);
2193}
2194
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002195/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given a type operand.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002196ExprResult
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002197Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
John McCall5ab75172009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002198 SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002199 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002200 if (!TInfo)
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002201 return ExprError();
2202
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002203 QualType T = TInfo->getType();
John McCall5ab75172009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002204
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002205 if (!T->isDependentType() &&
2206 CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(T, OpLoc, R, isSizeOf))
2207 return ExprError();
2208
2209 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002210 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, TInfo,
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002211 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2212 R.getEnd()));
2213}
2214
2215/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given an expression
2216/// operand.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002217ExprResult
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002218Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002219 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
2220 // Verify that the operand is valid.
2221 bool isInvalid = false;
2222 if (E->isTypeDependent()) {
2223 // Delay type-checking for type-dependent expressions.
2224 } else if (!isSizeOf) {
2225 isInvalid = CheckAlignOfExpr(E, OpLoc, R);
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002226 } else if (E->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.4p1.
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002227 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 0;
2228 isInvalid = true;
2229 } else {
2230 isInvalid = CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, R, true);
2231 }
2232
2233 if (isInvalid)
2234 return ExprError();
2235
2236 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
2237 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, E,
2238 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2239 R.getEnd()));
2240}
2241
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002242/// ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr - Handle @c sizeof(type) and @c sizeof @c expr and
2243/// the same for @c alignof and @c __alignof
2244/// Note that the ArgRange is invalid if isType is false.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002245ExprResult
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002246Sema::ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr(SourceLocation OpLoc, bool isSizeof, bool isType,
2247 void *TyOrEx, const SourceRange &ArgRange) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002248 // If error parsing type, ignore.
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002249 if (TyOrEx == 0) return ExprError();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002250
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002251 if (isType) {
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002252 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
John McCallb3d87482010-08-24 05:47:05 +00002253 (void) GetTypeFromParser(ParsedType::getFromOpaquePtr(TyOrEx), &TInfo);
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002254 return CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TInfo, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgRange);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002255 }
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002256
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002257 Expr *ArgEx = (Expr *)TyOrEx;
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002258 ExprResult Result
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002259 = CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(ArgEx, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgEx->getSourceRange());
2260
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002261 return move(Result);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002262}
2263
Chris Lattnerba27e2a2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00002264QualType Sema::CheckRealImagOperand(Expr *&V, SourceLocation Loc, bool isReal) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002265 if (V->isTypeDependent())
2266 return Context.DependentTy;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002267
Chris Lattnercc26ed72007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002268 // These operators return the element type of a complex type.
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002269 if (const ComplexType *CT = V->getType()->getAs<ComplexType>())
Chris Lattnerdbb36972007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002270 return CT->getElementType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002271
Chris Lattnercc26ed72007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002272 // Otherwise they pass through real integer and floating point types here.
2273 if (V->getType()->isArithmeticType())
2274 return V->getType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002275
Chris Lattnercc26ed72007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002276 // Reject anything else.
Chris Lattnerba27e2a2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00002277 Diag(Loc, diag::err_realimag_invalid_type) << V->getType()
2278 << (isReal ? "__real" : "__imag");
Chris Lattnercc26ed72007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002279 return QualType();
Chris Lattnerdbb36972007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002280}
2281
2282
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002283
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002284ExprResult
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002285Sema::ActOnPostfixUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002286 tok::TokenKind Kind, Expr *Input) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002287 UnaryOperatorKind Opc;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002288 switch (Kind) {
2289 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002290 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UO_PostInc; break;
2291 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UO_PostDec; break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002292 }
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002293
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002294 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, Opc, Input);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002295}
2296
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002297ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002298Sema::ActOnArraySubscriptExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2299 Expr *Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002300 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002301 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Base);
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002302 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
2303 Base = Result.take();
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002304
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002305 Expr *LHSExp = Base, *RHSExp = Idx;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002306
Douglas Gregor337c6b92008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002307 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Douglas Gregor3384c9c2009-05-19 00:01:19 +00002308 (LHSExp->isTypeDependent() || RHSExp->isTypeDependent())) {
Douglas Gregor3384c9c2009-05-19 00:01:19 +00002309 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
2310 Context.DependentTy, RLoc));
2311 }
2312
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002313 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002314 (LHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
Eli Friedman03f332a2008-12-15 22:34:21 +00002315 LHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType() ||
2316 RHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
2317 RHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType())) {
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002318 return CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(LLoc, RLoc, Base, Idx);
Douglas Gregor337c6b92008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002319 }
2320
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002321 return CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Base, LLoc, Idx, RLoc);
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002322}
2323
2324
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002325ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002326Sema::CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Expr *Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2327 Expr *Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
2328 Expr *LHSExp = Base;
2329 Expr *RHSExp = Idx;
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002330
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002331 // Perform default conversions.
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002332 if (!LHSExp->getType()->getAs<VectorType>())
2333 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHSExp);
2334 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHSExp);
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002335
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002336 QualType LHSTy = LHSExp->getType(), RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002337
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002338 // C99 6.5.2.1p2: the expression e1[e2] is by definition precisely equivalent
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00002339 // to the expression *((e1)+(e2)). This means the array "Base" may actually be
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002340 // in the subscript position. As a result, we need to derive the array base
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002341 // and index from the expression types.
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002342 Expr *BaseExpr, *IndexExpr;
2343 QualType ResultType;
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002344 if (LHSTy->isDependentType() || RHSTy->isDependentType()) {
2345 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2346 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2347 ResultType = Context.DependentTy;
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002348 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002349 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2350 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002351 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002352 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattner7a2e0472007-07-16 00:23:25 +00002353 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002354 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2355 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002356 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002357 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002358 LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002359 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2360 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2361 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002362 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002363 RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002364 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
2365 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2366 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
2367 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002368 } else if (const VectorType *VTy = LHSTy->getAs<VectorType>()) {
Chris Lattnerc8629632007-07-31 19:29:30 +00002369 BaseExpr = LHSExp; // vectors: V[123]
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002370 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Nate Begeman334a8022009-01-18 00:45:31 +00002371
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002372 // FIXME: need to deal with const...
2373 ResultType = VTy->getElementType();
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002374 } else if (LHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2375 // If we see an array that wasn't promoted by
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002376 // DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion, it must be an array that
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002377 // wasn't promoted because of the C90 rule that doesn't
2378 // allow promoting non-lvalue arrays. Warn, then
2379 // force the promotion here.
2380 Diag(LHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2381 LHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002382 ImpCastExprToType(LHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(LHSTy),
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002383 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002384 LHSTy = LHSExp->getType();
2385
2386 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2387 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002388 ResultType = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002389 } else if (RHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2390 // Same as previous, except for 123[f().a] case
2391 Diag(RHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2392 RHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002393 ImpCastExprToType(RHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(RHSTy),
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002394 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002395 RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
2396
2397 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2398 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002399 ResultType = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002400 } else {
Chris Lattner338395d2009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002401 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_value)
2402 << LHSExp->getSourceRange() << RHSExp->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002403 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002404 // C99 6.5.2.1p1
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00002405 if (!IndexExpr->getType()->isIntegerType() && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Chris Lattner338395d2009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002406 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
2407 << IndexExpr->getSourceRange());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002408
Daniel Dunbar7e88a602009-09-17 06:31:17 +00002409 if ((IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_S) ||
Sam Weinig0f9a5b52009-09-14 20:14:57 +00002410 IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_U))
2411 && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Sam Weinig76e2b712009-09-14 01:58:58 +00002412 Diag(LLoc, diag::warn_subscript_is_char) << IndexExpr->getSourceRange();
2413
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002414 // C99 6.5.2.1p1: "shall have type "pointer to *object* type". Similarly,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002415 // C++ [expr.sub]p1: The type "T" shall be a completely-defined object
2416 // type. Note that Functions are not objects, and that (in C99 parlance)
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002417 // incomplete types are not object types.
2418 if (ResultType->isFunctionType()) {
2419 Diag(BaseExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_subscript_function_type)
2420 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2421 return ExprError();
2422 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002423
Abramo Bagnara46358452010-09-13 06:50:07 +00002424 if (ResultType->isVoidType() && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
2425 // GNU extension: subscripting on pointer to void
2426 Diag(LLoc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
2427 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2428 } else if (!ResultType->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002429 RequireCompleteType(LLoc, ResultType,
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00002430 PDiag(diag::err_subscript_incomplete_type)
2431 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()))
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002432 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002433
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002434 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002435 if (ResultType->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002436 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_subscript_nonfragile_interface)
2437 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2438 return ExprError();
2439 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002440
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002441 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002442 ResultType, RLoc));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002443}
2444
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002445QualType Sema::
Nate Begeman213541a2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002446CheckExtVectorComponent(QualType baseType, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002447 const IdentifierInfo *CompName,
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002448 SourceLocation CompLoc) {
Daniel Dunbar2ad32892009-10-18 02:09:38 +00002449 // FIXME: Share logic with ExtVectorElementExpr::containsDuplicateElements,
2450 // see FIXME there.
2451 //
2452 // FIXME: This logic can be greatly simplified by splitting it along
2453 // halving/not halving and reworking the component checking.
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002454 const ExtVectorType *vecType = baseType->getAs<ExtVectorType>();
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002455
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002456 // The vector accessor can't exceed the number of elements.
Daniel Dunbare013d682009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002457 const char *compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002458
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002459 // This flag determines whether or not the component is one of the four
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002460 // special names that indicate a subset of exactly half the elements are
2461 // to be selected.
2462 bool HalvingSwizzle = false;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002463
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002464 // This flag determines whether or not CompName has an 's' char prefix,
2465 // indicating that it is a string of hex values to be used as vector indices.
Nate Begeman131f4652009-06-25 21:06:09 +00002466 bool HexSwizzle = *compStr == 's' || *compStr == 'S';
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002467
2468 // Check that we've found one of the special components, or that the component
2469 // names must come from the same set.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002470 if (!strcmp(compStr, "hi") || !strcmp(compStr, "lo") ||
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002471 !strcmp(compStr, "even") || !strcmp(compStr, "odd")) {
2472 HalvingSwizzle = true;
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002473 } else if (vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1) {
Chris Lattner88dca042007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002474 do
2475 compStr++;
2476 while (*compStr && vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1);
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002477 } else if (HexSwizzle || vecType->getNumericAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1) {
Chris Lattner88dca042007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002478 do
2479 compStr++;
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002480 while (*compStr && vecType->getNumericAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1);
Chris Lattner88dca042007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002481 }
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002482
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002483 if (!HalvingSwizzle && *compStr) {
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002484 // We didn't get to the end of the string. This means the component names
2485 // didn't come from the same set *or* we encountered an illegal name.
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00002486 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_name_illegal)
Benjamin Kramer476d8b82010-08-11 14:47:12 +00002487 << llvm::StringRef(compStr, 1) << SourceRange(CompLoc);
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002488 return QualType();
2489 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002490
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002491 // Ensure no component accessor exceeds the width of the vector type it
2492 // operates on.
2493 if (!HalvingSwizzle) {
Daniel Dunbare013d682009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002494 compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002495
2496 if (HexSwizzle)
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002497 compStr++;
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002498
2499 while (*compStr) {
2500 if (!vecType->isAccessorWithinNumElements(*compStr++)) {
2501 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_exceeds_length)
2502 << baseType << SourceRange(CompLoc);
2503 return QualType();
2504 }
2505 }
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002506 }
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002507
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002508 // The component accessor looks fine - now we need to compute the actual type.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002509 // The vector type is implied by the component accessor. For example,
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002510 // vec4.b is a float, vec4.xy is a vec2, vec4.rgb is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002511 // vec4.s0 is a float, vec4.s23 is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002512 // vec4.hi, vec4.lo, vec4.e, and vec4.o all return vec2.
Nate Begeman0479a0b2009-12-15 18:13:04 +00002513 unsigned CompSize = HalvingSwizzle ? (vecType->getNumElements() + 1) / 2
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002514 : CompName->getLength();
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002515 if (HexSwizzle)
2516 CompSize--;
2517
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002518 if (CompSize == 1)
2519 return vecType->getElementType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002520
Nate Begeman213541a2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002521 QualType VT = Context.getExtVectorType(vecType->getElementType(), CompSize);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002522 // Now look up the TypeDefDecl from the vector type. Without this,
Nate Begeman213541a2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002523 // diagostics look bad. We want extended vector types to appear built-in.
2524 for (unsigned i = 0, E = ExtVectorDecls.size(); i != E; ++i) {
2525 if (ExtVectorDecls[i]->getUnderlyingType() == VT)
2526 return Context.getTypedefType(ExtVectorDecls[i]);
Steve Naroffbea0b342007-07-29 16:33:31 +00002527 }
2528 return VT; // should never get here (a typedef type should always be found).
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002529}
2530
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002531static Decl *FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(const ObjCProtocolDecl*PDecl,
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002532 IdentifierInfo *Member,
Douglas Gregor6ab35242009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002533 const Selector &Sel,
2534 ASTContext &Context) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002535
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002536 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = PDecl->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member))
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002537 return PD;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis17945a02009-06-30 02:36:12 +00002538 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = PDecl->getInstanceMethod(Sel))
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002539 return OMD;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002540
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002541 for (ObjCProtocolDecl::protocol_iterator I = PDecl->protocol_begin(),
2542 E = PDecl->protocol_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002543 if (Decl *D = FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel,
Douglas Gregor6ab35242009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002544 Context))
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002545 return D;
2546 }
2547 return 0;
2548}
2549
Steve Naroffd1b3c2d2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002550static Decl *FindGetterNameDecl(const ObjCObjectPointerType *QIdTy,
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002551 IdentifierInfo *Member,
Douglas Gregor6ab35242009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002552 const Selector &Sel,
2553 ASTContext &Context) {
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002554 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
2555 Decl *GDecl = 0;
Steve Naroffd1b3c2d2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002556 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002557 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002558 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = (*I)->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member)) {
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002559 GDecl = PD;
2560 break;
2561 }
2562 // Also must look for a getter name which uses property syntax.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis17945a02009-06-30 02:36:12 +00002563 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = (*I)->getInstanceMethod(Sel)) {
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002564 GDecl = OMD;
2565 break;
2566 }
2567 }
2568 if (!GDecl) {
Steve Naroffd1b3c2d2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002569 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002570 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
2571 // Search in the protocol-qualifier list of current protocol.
Douglas Gregor6ab35242009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002572 GDecl = FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel, Context);
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002573 if (GDecl)
2574 return GDecl;
2575 }
2576 }
2577 return GDecl;
2578}
Chris Lattner76a642f2009-02-15 22:43:40 +00002579
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002580ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002581Sema::ActOnDependentMemberExpr(Expr *BaseExpr, QualType BaseType,
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002582 bool IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002583 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
2584 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002585 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002586 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002587 // Even in dependent contexts, try to diagnose base expressions with
2588 // obviously wrong types, e.g.:
2589 //
2590 // T* t;
2591 // t.f;
2592 //
2593 // In Obj-C++, however, the above expression is valid, since it could be
2594 // accessing the 'f' property if T is an Obj-C interface. The extra check
2595 // allows this, while still reporting an error if T is a struct pointer.
2596 if (!IsArrow) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002597 const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002598 if (PT && (!getLangOptions().ObjC1 ||
2599 PT->getPointeeType()->isRecordType())) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002600 assert(BaseExpr && "cannot happen with implicit member accesses");
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002601 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(), diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002602 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002603 return ExprError();
2604 }
2605 }
2606
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002607 assert(BaseType->isDependentType() ||
2608 NameInfo.getName().isDependentName() ||
Douglas Gregor01e56ae2010-04-12 20:54:26 +00002609 isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS));
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002610
2611 // Get the type being accessed in BaseType. If this is an arrow, the BaseExpr
2612 // must have pointer type, and the accessed type is the pointee.
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002613 return Owned(CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create(Context, BaseExpr, BaseType,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002614 IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002615 SS.getScopeRep(),
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002616 SS.getRange(),
2617 FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002618 NameInfo, TemplateArgs));
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002619}
2620
2621/// We know that the given qualified member reference points only to
2622/// declarations which do not belong to the static type of the base
2623/// expression. Diagnose the problem.
2624static void DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(Sema &SemaRef,
2625 Expr *BaseExpr,
2626 QualType BaseType,
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002627 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002628 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002629 // If this is an implicit member access, use a different set of
2630 // diagnostics.
2631 if (!BaseExpr)
2632 return DiagnoseInstanceReference(SemaRef, SS, R);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002633
John McCall110acc12010-04-27 01:43:38 +00002634 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_qualified_member_of_unrelated)
2635 << SS.getRange() << R.getRepresentativeDecl() << BaseType;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002636}
2637
2638// Check whether the declarations we found through a nested-name
2639// specifier in a member expression are actually members of the base
2640// type. The restriction here is:
2641//
2642// C++ [expr.ref]p2:
2643// ... In these cases, the id-expression shall name a
2644// member of the class or of one of its base classes.
2645//
2646// So it's perfectly legitimate for the nested-name specifier to name
2647// an unrelated class, and for us to find an overload set including
2648// decls from classes which are not superclasses, as long as the decl
2649// we actually pick through overload resolution is from a superclass.
2650bool Sema::CheckQualifiedMemberReference(Expr *BaseExpr,
2651 QualType BaseType,
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002652 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002653 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002654 const RecordType *BaseRT = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>();
2655 if (!BaseRT) {
2656 // We can't check this yet because the base type is still
2657 // dependent.
2658 assert(BaseType->isDependentType());
2659 return false;
2660 }
2661 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002662
2663 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002664 // If this is an implicit member reference and we find a
2665 // non-instance member, it's not an error.
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002666 if (!BaseExpr && !(*I)->isCXXInstanceMember())
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002667 return false;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002668
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002669 // Note that we use the DC of the decl, not the underlying decl.
Eli Friedman02463762010-07-27 20:51:02 +00002670 DeclContext *DC = (*I)->getDeclContext();
2671 while (DC->isTransparentContext())
2672 DC = DC->getParent();
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002673
Douglas Gregor9d4bb942010-07-28 22:27:52 +00002674 if (!DC->isRecord())
2675 continue;
2676
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002677 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*,4> MemberRecord;
Eli Friedman02463762010-07-27 20:51:02 +00002678 MemberRecord.insert(cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)->getCanonicalDecl());
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002679
2680 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(*this, BaseRecord, MemberRecord))
2681 return false;
2682 }
2683
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002684 DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(*this, BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002685 return true;
2686}
2687
2688static bool
2689LookupMemberExprInRecord(Sema &SemaRef, LookupResult &R,
2690 SourceRange BaseRange, const RecordType *RTy,
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002691 SourceLocation OpLoc, CXXScopeSpec &SS,
2692 bool HasTemplateArgs) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002693 RecordDecl *RDecl = RTy->getDecl();
2694 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, QualType(RTy, 0),
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00002695 SemaRef.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002696 << BaseRange))
2697 return true;
2698
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002699 if (HasTemplateArgs) {
2700 // LookupTemplateName doesn't expect these both to exist simultaneously.
2701 QualType ObjectType = SS.isSet() ? QualType() : QualType(RTy, 0);
2702
2703 bool MOUS;
2704 SemaRef.LookupTemplateName(R, 0, SS, ObjectType, false, MOUS);
2705 return false;
2706 }
2707
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002708 DeclContext *DC = RDecl;
2709 if (SS.isSet()) {
2710 // If the member name was a qualified-id, look into the
2711 // nested-name-specifier.
2712 DC = SemaRef.computeDeclContext(SS, false);
2713
John McCall77bb1aa2010-05-01 00:40:08 +00002714 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC)) {
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002715 SemaRef.Diag(SS.getRange().getEnd(), diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
2716 << SS.getRange() << DC;
2717 return true;
2718 }
2719
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002720 assert(DC && "Cannot handle non-computable dependent contexts in lookup");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002721
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002722 if (!isa<TypeDecl>(DC)) {
2723 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_qualified_member_nonclass)
2724 << DC << SS.getRange();
2725 return true;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002726 }
2727 }
2728
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002729 // The record definition is complete, now look up the member.
2730 SemaRef.LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002731
Douglas Gregor2dcc0112009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002732 if (!R.empty())
2733 return false;
2734
2735 // We didn't find anything with the given name, so try to correct
2736 // for typos.
2737 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00002738 if (SemaRef.CorrectTypo(R, 0, &SS, DC, false, Sema::CTC_MemberLookup) &&
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +00002739 !R.empty() &&
Douglas Gregor2dcc0112009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002740 (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin()))) {
2741 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
2742 << Name << DC << R.getLookupName() << SS.getRange()
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00002743 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
2744 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
Douglas Gregor67dd1d42010-01-07 00:17:44 +00002745 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
2746 SemaRef.Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
2747 << ND->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregor2dcc0112009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002748 return false;
2749 } else {
2750 R.clear();
Douglas Gregor12eb5d62010-06-29 19:27:42 +00002751 R.setLookupName(Name);
Douglas Gregor2dcc0112009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002752 }
2753
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002754 return false;
2755}
2756
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002757ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002758Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Expr *Base, QualType BaseType,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002759 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
Jeffrey Yasskin9ab14542010-04-08 16:38:48 +00002760 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002761 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002762 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002763 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002764 if (BaseType->isDependentType() ||
2765 (SS.isSet() && isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS)))
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002766 return ActOnDependentMemberExpr(Base, BaseType,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002767 IsArrow, OpLoc,
2768 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002769 NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002770
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002771 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupMemberName);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002772
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002773 // Implicit member accesses.
2774 if (!Base) {
2775 QualType RecordTy = BaseType;
2776 if (IsArrow) RecordTy = RecordTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
2777 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, SourceRange(),
2778 RecordTy->getAs<RecordType>(),
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002779 OpLoc, SS, TemplateArgs != 0))
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002780 return ExprError();
2781
2782 // Explicit member accesses.
2783 } else {
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002784 ExprResult Result =
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002785 LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCalld226f652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00002786 SS, /*ObjCImpDecl*/ 0, TemplateArgs != 0);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002787
2788 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
2789 Owned(Base);
2790 return ExprError();
2791 }
2792
2793 if (Result.get())
2794 return move(Result);
Sebastian Redlf3e63372010-05-07 09:25:11 +00002795
2796 // LookupMemberExpr can modify Base, and thus change BaseType
2797 BaseType = Base->getType();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002798 }
2799
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002800 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Base, BaseType,
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002801 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
2802 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002803}
2804
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002805ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002806Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Expr *BaseExpr, QualType BaseExprType,
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002807 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
2808 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002809 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002810 LookupResult &R,
Douglas Gregor06a9f362010-05-01 20:49:11 +00002811 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
2812 bool SuppressQualifierCheck) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002813 QualType BaseType = BaseExprType;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002814 if (IsArrow) {
2815 assert(BaseType->isPointerType());
2816 BaseType = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
2817 }
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002818 R.setBaseObjectType(BaseType);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002819
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002820 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = SS.getScopeRep();
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002821 const DeclarationNameInfo &MemberNameInfo = R.getLookupNameInfo();
2822 DeclarationName MemberName = MemberNameInfo.getName();
2823 SourceLocation MemberLoc = MemberNameInfo.getLoc();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002824
2825 if (R.isAmbiguous())
Douglas Gregorfe85ced2009-08-06 03:17:00 +00002826 return ExprError();
2827
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002828 if (R.empty()) {
2829 // Rederive where we looked up.
2830 DeclContext *DC = (SS.isSet()
2831 ? computeDeclContext(SS, false)
2832 : BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002833
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002834 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002835 << MemberName << DC
2836 << (BaseExpr ? BaseExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange());
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002837 return ExprError();
2838 }
2839
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002840 // Diagnose lookups that find only declarations from a non-base
2841 // type. This is possible for either qualified lookups (which may
2842 // have been qualified with an unrelated type) or implicit member
2843 // expressions (which were found with unqualified lookup and thus
2844 // may have come from an enclosing scope). Note that it's okay for
2845 // lookup to find declarations from a non-base type as long as those
2846 // aren't the ones picked by overload resolution.
2847 if ((SS.isSet() || !BaseExpr ||
2848 (isa<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr) &&
2849 cast<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr)->isImplicit())) &&
Douglas Gregor06a9f362010-05-01 20:49:11 +00002850 !SuppressQualifierCheck &&
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002851 CheckQualifiedMemberReference(BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R))
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002852 return ExprError();
2853
2854 // Construct an unresolved result if we in fact got an unresolved
2855 // result.
2856 if (R.isOverloadedResult() || R.isUnresolvableResult()) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002857 bool Dependent =
John McCall410a3f32009-12-19 02:05:44 +00002858 BaseExprType->isDependentType() ||
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002859 R.isUnresolvableResult() ||
John McCall7bb12da2010-02-02 06:20:04 +00002860 OverloadExpr::ComputeDependence(R.begin(), R.end(), TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002861
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +00002862 // Suppress any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll do these when we
2863 // pick a member.
2864 R.suppressDiagnostics();
2865
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002866 UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemExpr
2867 = UnresolvedMemberExpr::Create(Context, Dependent,
2868 R.isUnresolvableResult(),
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002869 BaseExpr, BaseExprType,
2870 IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002871 Qualifier, SS.getRange(),
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002872 MemberNameInfo,
Douglas Gregor5a84dec2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00002873 TemplateArgs, R.begin(), R.end());
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002874
2875 return Owned(MemExpr);
2876 }
2877
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002878 assert(R.isSingleResult());
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002879 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = R.begin().getPair();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002880 NamedDecl *MemberDecl = R.getFoundDecl();
2881
2882 // FIXME: diagnose the presence of template arguments now.
2883
2884 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
2885 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
2886 // error cases.
2887 if (MemberDecl->isInvalidDecl())
2888 return ExprError();
2889
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002890 // Handle the implicit-member-access case.
2891 if (!BaseExpr) {
2892 // If this is not an instance member, convert to a non-member access.
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002893 if (!MemberDecl->isCXXInstanceMember())
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002894 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getLookupNameInfo(), MemberDecl);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002895
Douglas Gregor828a1972010-01-07 23:12:05 +00002896 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
2897 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
2898 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
2899 BaseExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, BaseExprType,/*isImplicit=*/true);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002900 }
2901
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002902 bool ShouldCheckUse = true;
2903 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2904 // Don't diagnose the use of a virtual member function unless it's
2905 // explicitly qualified.
2906 if (MD->isVirtual() && !SS.isSet())
2907 ShouldCheckUse = false;
2908 }
2909
2910 // Check the use of this member.
2911 if (ShouldCheckUse && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(MemberDecl, MemberLoc)) {
2912 Owned(BaseExpr);
2913 return ExprError();
2914 }
2915
2916 if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2917 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
2918 // (C++ [class.union]).
Eli Friedman16c53782009-12-04 07:18:51 +00002919 if (cast<RecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion() &&
2920 !BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl()->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002921 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(MemberLoc, FD,
2922 BaseExpr, OpLoc);
2923
2924 // Figure out the type of the member; see C99 6.5.2.3p3, C++ [expr.ref]
2925 QualType MemberType = FD->getType();
2926 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = MemberType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
2927 MemberType = Ref->getPointeeType();
2928 else {
2929 Qualifiers BaseQuals = BaseType.getQualifiers();
2930 BaseQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
2931 if (FD->isMutable()) BaseQuals.removeConst();
2932
2933 Qualifiers MemberQuals
2934 = Context.getCanonicalType(MemberType).getQualifiers();
2935
2936 Qualifiers Combined = BaseQuals + MemberQuals;
2937 if (Combined != MemberQuals)
2938 MemberType = Context.getQualifiedType(MemberType, Combined);
2939 }
2940
2941 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, FD);
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002942 if (PerformObjectMemberConversion(BaseExpr, Qualifier, FoundDecl, FD))
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002943 return ExprError();
2944 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002945 FD, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
2946 MemberType));
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002947 }
2948
2949 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2950 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, Var);
2951 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002952 Var, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002953 Var->getType().getNonReferenceType()));
2954 }
2955
2956 if (FunctionDecl *MemberFn = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2957 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
2958 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002959 MemberFn, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002960 MemberFn->getType()));
2961 }
2962
2963 if (EnumConstantDecl *Enum = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2964 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
2965 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002966 Enum, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
2967 Enum->getType()));
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002968 }
2969
2970 Owned(BaseExpr);
2971
Douglas Gregorb0fd4832010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002972 // We found something that we didn't expect. Complain.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002973 if (isa<TypeDecl>(MemberDecl))
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002974 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_type)
Douglas Gregorb0fd4832010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002975 << MemberName << BaseType << int(IsArrow);
2976 else
2977 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_unknown)
2978 << MemberName << BaseType << int(IsArrow);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002979
Douglas Gregorb0fd4832010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002980 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_member_declared_here)
2981 << MemberName;
Douglas Gregor2b147f02010-04-25 21:15:30 +00002982 R.suppressDiagnostics();
Douglas Gregorb0fd4832010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002983 return ExprError();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002984}
2985
2986/// Look up the given member of the given non-type-dependent
2987/// expression. This can return in one of two ways:
2988/// * If it returns a sentinel null-but-valid result, the caller will
2989/// assume that lookup was performed and the results written into
2990/// the provided structure. It will take over from there.
2991/// * Otherwise, the returned expression will be produced in place of
2992/// an ordinary member expression.
2993///
2994/// The ObjCImpDecl bit is a gross hack that will need to be properly
2995/// fixed for ObjC++.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002996ExprResult
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002997Sema::LookupMemberExpr(LookupResult &R, Expr *&BaseExpr,
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00002998 bool &IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Jeffrey Yasskin9ab14542010-04-08 16:38:48 +00002999 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCalld226f652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003000 Decl *ObjCImpDecl, bool HasTemplateArgs) {
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003001 assert(BaseExpr && "no base expression");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003002
Steve Naroff3cc4af82007-12-16 21:42:28 +00003003 // Perform default conversions.
3004 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003005
Steve Naroffdfa6aae2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00003006 QualType BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003007 assert(!BaseType->isDependentType());
3008
3009 DeclarationName MemberName = R.getLookupName();
3010 SourceLocation MemberLoc = R.getNameLoc();
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003011
3012 // If the user is trying to apply -> or . to a function pointer
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003013 // type, it's probably because they forgot parentheses to call that
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003014 // function. Suggest the addition of those parentheses, build the
3015 // call, and continue on.
3016 if (const PointerType *Ptr = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
3017 if (const FunctionProtoType *Fun
3018 = Ptr->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
3019 QualType ResultTy = Fun->getResultType();
3020 if (Fun->getNumArgs() == 0 &&
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003021 ((!IsArrow && ResultTy->isRecordType()) ||
3022 (IsArrow && ResultTy->isPointerType() &&
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003023 ResultTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()
3024 ->isRecordType()))) {
3025 SourceLocation Loc = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(BaseExpr->getLocEnd());
3026 Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_reference_needs_call)
3027 << QualType(Fun, 0)
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003028 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Loc, "()");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003029
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003030 ExprResult NewBase
Douglas Gregora1a04782010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003031 = ActOnCallExpr(0, BaseExpr, Loc, MultiExprArg(*this, 0, 0), Loc);
Douglas Gregorf918b832010-06-21 22:46:46 +00003032 BaseExpr = 0;
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003033 if (NewBase.isInvalid())
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003034 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003035
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003036 BaseExpr = NewBase.takeAs<Expr>();
3037 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
3038 BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
3039 }
3040 }
3041 }
3042
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003043 // If this is an Objective-C pseudo-builtin and a definition is provided then
3044 // use that.
3045 if (BaseType->isObjCIdType()) {
Fariborz Jahanian6d910f02009-12-07 20:09:25 +00003046 if (IsArrow) {
3047 // Handle the following exceptional case PObj->isa.
3048 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
3049 BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003050 if (OPT->getObjectType()->isObjCId() &&
Fariborz Jahanian6d910f02009-12-07 20:09:25 +00003051 MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("isa"))
Fariborz Jahanian83dc3252009-12-09 19:05:56 +00003052 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIsaExpr(BaseExpr, true, MemberLoc,
3053 Context.getObjCClassType()));
Fariborz Jahanian6d910f02009-12-07 20:09:25 +00003054 }
3055 }
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003056 // We have an 'id' type. Rather than fall through, we check if this
3057 // is a reference to 'isa'.
3058 if (BaseType != Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType) {
3059 BaseType = Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003060 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CK_BitCast);
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003061 }
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003062 }
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003063
Fariborz Jahanian369a3bd2009-11-25 23:07:42 +00003064 // If this is an Objective-C pseudo-builtin and a definition is provided then
3065 // use that.
3066 if (Context.isObjCSelType(BaseType)) {
3067 // We have an 'SEL' type. Rather than fall through, we check if this
3068 // is a reference to 'sel_id'.
3069 if (BaseType != Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType) {
3070 BaseType = Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003071 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanian369a3bd2009-11-25 23:07:42 +00003072 }
3073 }
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003074
Steve Naroffdfa6aae2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00003075 assert(!BaseType.isNull() && "no type for member expression");
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003076
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003077 // Handle properties on ObjC 'Class' types.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003078 if (!IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCClassType()) {
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003079 // Also must look for a getter name which uses property syntax.
3080 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
3081 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
3082 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl()) {
3083 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = MD->getClassInterface();
3084 ObjCMethodDecl *Getter;
3085 // FIXME: need to also look locally in the implementation.
3086 if ((Getter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(Sel))) {
3087 // Check the use of this method.
3088 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Getter, MemberLoc))
3089 return ExprError();
3090 }
3091 // If we found a getter then this may be a valid dot-reference, we
3092 // will look for the matching setter, in case it is needed.
3093 Selector SetterSel =
3094 SelectorTable::constructSetterName(PP.getIdentifierTable(),
3095 PP.getSelectorTable(), Member);
3096 ObjCMethodDecl *Setter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(SetterSel);
3097 if (!Setter) {
3098 // If this reference is in an @implementation, also check for 'private'
3099 // methods.
Steve Naroffd789d3d2009-10-01 23:46:04 +00003100 Setter = IFace->lookupPrivateInstanceMethod(SetterSel);
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003101 }
3102 // Look through local category implementations associated with the class.
3103 if (!Setter)
3104 Setter = IFace->getCategoryClassMethod(SetterSel);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003105
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003106 if (Setter && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Setter, MemberLoc))
3107 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003108
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003109 if (Getter || Setter) {
3110 QualType PType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003111
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003112 if (Getter)
Douglas Gregor5291c3c2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003113 PType = Getter->getSendResultType();
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003114 else
3115 // Get the expression type from Setter's incoming parameter.
3116 PType = (*(Setter->param_end() -1))->getType();
3117 // FIXME: we must check that the setter has property type.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003118 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr(Getter,
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003119 PType,
3120 Setter, MemberLoc, BaseExpr));
3121 }
3122 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
3123 << MemberName << BaseType);
3124 }
3125 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003126
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003127 if (BaseType->isObjCClassType() &&
3128 BaseType != Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType) {
3129 BaseType = Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003130 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003131 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003132
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003133 if (IsArrow) {
3134 if (const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroffdfa6aae2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00003135 BaseType = PT->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003136 else if (BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType())
3137 ;
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003138 else if (BaseType->isRecordType()) {
3139 // Recover from arrow accesses to records, e.g.:
3140 // struct MyRecord foo;
3141 // foo->bar
3142 // This is actually well-formed in C++ if MyRecord has an
3143 // overloaded operator->, but that should have been dealt with
3144 // by now.
3145 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
3146 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003147 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, ".");
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003148 IsArrow = false;
3149 } else {
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003150 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_arrow)
3151 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3152 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson4ef27702009-05-16 20:31:20 +00003153 }
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003154 } else {
3155 // Recover from dot accesses to pointers, e.g.:
3156 // type *foo;
3157 // foo.bar
3158 // This is actually well-formed in two cases:
3159 // - 'type' is an Objective C type
3160 // - 'bar' is a pseudo-destructor name which happens to refer to
3161 // the appropriate pointer type
3162 if (MemberName.getNameKind() != DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName) {
3163 const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>();
3164 if (PT && PT->getPointeeType()->isRecordType()) {
3165 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
3166 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003167 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, "->");
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003168 BaseType = PT->getPointeeType();
3169 IsArrow = true;
3170 }
3171 }
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003172 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003173
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003174 // Handle field access to simple records.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003175 if (const RecordType *RTy = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003176 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, BaseExpr->getSourceRange(),
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003177 RTy, OpLoc, SS, HasTemplateArgs))
Douglas Gregor4ec339f2009-01-19 19:26:10 +00003178 return ExprError();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003179 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003180 }
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003181
Chris Lattnera38e6b12008-07-21 04:59:05 +00003182 // Handle access to Objective-C instance variables, such as "Obj->ivar" and
3183 // (*Obj).ivar.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003184 if ((IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003185 (!IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCObjectType())) {
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003186 const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003187 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl =
3188 OPT ? OPT->getInterfaceDecl()
3189 : BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()->getInterface();
3190 if (IDecl) {
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003191 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
3192
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003193 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003194 ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IDecl->lookupInstanceVariable(Member, ClassDeclared);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003195
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003196 if (!IV) {
3197 // Attempt to correct for typos in ivar names.
3198 LookupResult Res(*this, R.getLookupName(), R.getNameLoc(),
3199 LookupMemberName);
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +00003200 if (CorrectTypo(Res, 0, 0, IDecl, false, CTC_MemberLookup) &&
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003201 (IV = Res.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>())) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003202 Diag(R.getNameLoc(),
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003203 diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar_suggest)
3204 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName << IV->getDeclName()
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003205 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
3206 IV->getNameAsString());
Douglas Gregor67dd1d42010-01-07 00:17:44 +00003207 Diag(IV->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003208 << IV->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregor12eb5d62010-06-29 19:27:42 +00003209 } else {
3210 Res.clear();
3211 Res.setLookupName(Member);
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003212 }
3213 }
3214
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003215 if (IV) {
3216 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
3217 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
3218 // error cases.
3219 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
3220 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00003221
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003222 // Check whether we can reference this field.
3223 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, MemberLoc))
3224 return ExprError();
3225 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Public &&
3226 IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Package) {
3227 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassOfMethodDecl = 0;
3228 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl())
3229 ClassOfMethodDecl = MD->getClassInterface();
3230 else if (ObjCImpDecl && getCurFunctionDecl()) {
3231 // Case of a c-function declared inside an objc implementation.
3232 // FIXME: For a c-style function nested inside an objc implementation
3233 // class, there is no implementation context available, so we pass
3234 // down the context as argument to this routine. Ideally, this context
3235 // need be passed down in the AST node and somehow calculated from the
3236 // AST for a function decl.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003237 if (ObjCImplementationDecl *IMPD =
John McCalld226f652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003238 dyn_cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(ObjCImpDecl))
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003239 ClassOfMethodDecl = IMPD->getClassInterface();
3240 else if (ObjCCategoryImplDecl* CatImplClass =
John McCalld226f652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003241 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(ObjCImpDecl))
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003242 ClassOfMethodDecl = CatImplClass->getClassInterface();
3243 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003244
3245 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private) {
3246 if (ClassDeclared != IDecl ||
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003247 ClassOfMethodDecl != ClassDeclared)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003248 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_private_ivar_access)
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003249 << IV->getDeclName();
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00003250 } else if (!IDecl->isSuperClassOf(ClassOfMethodDecl))
3251 // @protected
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003252 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_protected_ivar_access)
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003253 << IV->getDeclName();
Steve Naroffb06d8752009-03-04 18:34:24 +00003254 }
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003255
3256 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(),
3257 MemberLoc, BaseExpr,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003258 IsArrow));
Fariborz Jahanian935fd762009-03-03 01:21:12 +00003259 }
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003260 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar)
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003261 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003262 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange());
Fariborz Jahanianaaa63a72008-12-13 22:20:28 +00003263 }
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003264 }
Steve Naroffde2e22d2009-07-15 18:40:39 +00003265 // Handle properties on 'id' and qualified "id".
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003266 if (!IsArrow && (BaseType->isObjCIdType() ||
3267 BaseType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())) {
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003268 const ObjCObjectPointerType *QIdTy = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003269 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003270
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003271 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003272 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003273 if (Decl *PMDecl = FindGetterNameDecl(QIdTy, Member, Sel, Context)) {
3274 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = dyn_cast<ObjCPropertyDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3275 // Check the use of this declaration
3276 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(PD, MemberLoc))
3277 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003278
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003279 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCPropertyRefExpr(PD, PD->getType(),
3280 MemberLoc, BaseExpr));
3281 }
3282 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3283 // Check the use of this method.
3284 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(OMD, MemberLoc))
3285 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003286
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003287 return Owned(ObjCMessageExpr::Create(Context,
Douglas Gregor5291c3c2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003288 OMD->getSendResultType(),
Douglas Gregor04badcf2010-04-21 00:45:42 +00003289 OpLoc, BaseExpr, Sel,
3290 OMD, NULL, 0, MemberLoc));
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003291 }
3292 }
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003293
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003294 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003295 << MemberName << BaseType);
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003296 }
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003297
Chris Lattnera38e6b12008-07-21 04:59:05 +00003298 // Handle Objective-C property access, which is "Obj.property" where Obj is a
3299 // pointer to a (potentially qualified) interface type.
Chris Lattner7f816522010-04-11 07:45:24 +00003300 if (!IsArrow)
3301 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
3302 BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())
Chris Lattnerb9d4fc12010-04-11 07:51:10 +00003303 return HandleExprPropertyRefExpr(OPT, BaseExpr, MemberName, MemberLoc);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003304
Steve Narofff242b1b2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003305 // Handle the following exceptional case (*Obj).isa.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003306 if (!IsArrow &&
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003307 BaseType->isObjCObjectType() &&
3308 BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()->isObjCId() &&
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003309 MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("isa"))
Steve Narofff242b1b2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003310 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIsaExpr(BaseExpr, false, MemberLoc,
Fariborz Jahanian83dc3252009-12-09 19:05:56 +00003311 Context.getObjCClassType()));
Steve Narofff242b1b2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003312
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003313 // Handle 'field access' to vectors, such as 'V.xx'.
Chris Lattner73525de2009-02-16 21:11:58 +00003314 if (BaseType->isExtVectorType()) {
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003315 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003316 QualType ret = CheckExtVectorComponent(BaseType, OpLoc, Member, MemberLoc);
3317 if (ret.isNull())
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003318 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003319 return Owned(new (Context) ExtVectorElementExpr(ret, BaseExpr, *Member,
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00003320 MemberLoc));
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003321 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003322
Douglas Gregor214f31a2009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003323 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
3324 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3325
Douglas Gregor214f31a2009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003326 return ExprError();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00003327}
3328
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003329/// The main callback when the parser finds something like
3330/// expression . [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3331/// expression -> [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3332/// where 'identifier' encompasses a fairly broad spectrum of
3333/// possibilities, including destructor and operator references.
3334///
3335/// \param OpKind either tok::arrow or tok::period
3336/// \param HasTrailingLParen whether the next token is '(', which
3337/// is used to diagnose mis-uses of special members that can
3338/// only be called
3339/// \param ObjCImpDecl the current ObjC @implementation decl;
3340/// this is an ugly hack around the fact that ObjC @implementations
3341/// aren't properly put in the context chain
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003342ExprResult Sema::ActOnMemberAccessExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Base,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003343 SourceLocation OpLoc,
3344 tok::TokenKind OpKind,
Jeffrey Yasskin9ab14542010-04-08 16:38:48 +00003345 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003346 UnqualifiedId &Id,
John McCalld226f652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003347 Decl *ObjCImpDecl,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003348 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
3349 if (SS.isSet() && SS.isInvalid())
3350 return ExprError();
3351
3352 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
3353
3354 // Decompose the name into its component parts.
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003355 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003356 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
3357 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003358 NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003359
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003360 DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003361 bool IsArrow = (OpKind == tok::arrow);
3362
3363 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope
3364 = (!SS.isSet() ? 0 : FindFirstQualifierInScope(S,
3365 static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier*>(SS.getScopeRep())));
3366
3367 // This is a postfix expression, so get rid of ParenListExprs.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003368 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Base);
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003369 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
3370 Base = Result.take();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003371
Douglas Gregor01e56ae2010-04-12 20:54:26 +00003372 if (Base->getType()->isDependentType() || Name.isDependentName() ||
3373 isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS)) {
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003374 Result = ActOnDependentMemberExpr(Base, Base->getType(),
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003375 IsArrow, OpLoc,
3376 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003377 NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003378 } else {
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003379 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupMemberName);
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003380 Result = LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
3381 SS, ObjCImpDecl, TemplateArgs != 0);
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003382
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003383 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
3384 Owned(Base);
3385 return ExprError();
3386 }
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003387
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003388 if (Result.get()) {
3389 // The only way a reference to a destructor can be used is to
3390 // immediately call it, which falls into this case. If the
3391 // next token is not a '(', produce a diagnostic and build the
3392 // call now.
3393 if (!HasTrailingLParen &&
3394 Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_DestructorName)
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003395 return DiagnoseDtorReference(NameInfo.getLoc(), Result.get());
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003396
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003397 return move(Result);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003398 }
3399
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003400 Result = BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Base, Base->getType(),
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00003401 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
3402 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003403 }
3404
3405 return move(Result);
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003406}
3407
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003408ExprResult Sema::BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(SourceLocation CallLoc,
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003409 FunctionDecl *FD,
3410 ParmVarDecl *Param) {
3411 if (Param->hasUnparsedDefaultArg()) {
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003412 Diag(CallLoc,
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003413 diag::err_use_of_default_argument_to_function_declared_later) <<
3414 FD << cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->getDeclName();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003415 Diag(UnparsedDefaultArgLocs[Param],
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003416 diag::note_default_argument_declared_here);
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003417 return ExprError();
3418 }
3419
3420 if (Param->hasUninstantiatedDefaultArg()) {
3421 Expr *UninstExpr = Param->getUninstantiatedDefaultArg();
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003422
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003423 // Instantiate the expression.
3424 MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList ArgList
3425 = getTemplateInstantiationArgs(FD, 0, /*RelativeToPrimary=*/true);
Anders Carlsson25cae7f2009-09-05 05:14:19 +00003426
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003427 std::pair<const TemplateArgument *, unsigned> Innermost
3428 = ArgList.getInnermost();
3429 InstantiatingTemplate Inst(*this, CallLoc, Param, Innermost.first,
3430 Innermost.second);
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003431
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003432 ExprResult Result = SubstExpr(UninstExpr, ArgList);
3433 if (Result.isInvalid())
3434 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003435
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003436 // Check the expression as an initializer for the parameter.
3437 InitializedEntity Entity
3438 = InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Param);
3439 InitializationKind Kind
3440 = InitializationKind::CreateCopy(Param->getLocation(),
3441 /*FIXME:EqualLoc*/UninstExpr->getSourceRange().getBegin());
3442 Expr *ResultE = Result.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor65222e82009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003443
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003444 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &ResultE, 1);
3445 Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
3446 MultiExprArg(*this, &ResultE, 1));
3447 if (Result.isInvalid())
3448 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003449
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003450 // Build the default argument expression.
3451 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param,
3452 Result.takeAs<Expr>()));
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003453 }
3454
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003455 // If the default expression creates temporaries, we need to
3456 // push them to the current stack of expression temporaries so they'll
3457 // be properly destroyed.
3458 // FIXME: We should really be rebuilding the default argument with new
3459 // bound temporaries; see the comment in PR5810.
Douglas Gregor5833b0b2010-09-14 22:55:20 +00003460 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Param->getNumDefaultArgTemporaries(); i != e; ++i) {
3461 CXXTemporary *Temporary = Param->getDefaultArgTemporary(i);
3462 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Param->getDefaultArg()->getLocStart(),
3463 const_cast<CXXDestructorDecl*>(Temporary->getDestructor()));
3464 ExprTemporaries.push_back(Temporary);
3465 }
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003466
3467 // We already type-checked the argument, so we know it works.
Douglas Gregor4fcf5b22010-09-11 23:32:50 +00003468 // Just mark all of the declarations in this potentially-evaluated expression
3469 // as being "referenced".
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003470 MarkDeclarationsReferencedInExpr(Param->getDefaultArg());
Douglas Gregor036aed12009-12-23 23:03:06 +00003471 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param));
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003472}
3473
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003474/// ConvertArgumentsForCall - Converts the arguments specified in
3475/// Args/NumArgs to the parameter types of the function FDecl with
3476/// function prototype Proto. Call is the call expression itself, and
3477/// Fn is the function expression. For a C++ member function, this
3478/// routine does not attempt to convert the object argument. Returns
3479/// true if the call is ill-formed.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003480bool
3481Sema::ConvertArgumentsForCall(CallExpr *Call, Expr *Fn,
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003482 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003483 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003484 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3485 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003486 // C99 6.5.2.2p7 - the arguments are implicitly converted, as if by
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003487 // assignment, to the types of the corresponding parameter, ...
3488 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
Douglas Gregor3fd56d72009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003489 bool Invalid = false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003490
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003491 // If too few arguments are available (and we don't have default
3492 // arguments for the remaining parameters), don't make the call.
3493 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto) {
3494 if (!FDecl || NumArgs < FDecl->getMinRequiredArguments())
3495 return Diag(RParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args)
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003496 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
Eric Christopherd77b9a22010-04-16 04:48:22 +00003497 << NumArgsInProto << NumArgs << Fn->getSourceRange();
Ted Kremenek8189cde2009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003498 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003499 }
3500
3501 // If too many are passed and not variadic, error on the extras and drop
3502 // them.
3503 if (NumArgs > NumArgsInProto) {
3504 if (!Proto->isVariadic()) {
3505 Diag(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
3506 diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args)
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003507 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
Eric Christopherccfa9632010-04-16 04:56:46 +00003508 << NumArgsInProto << NumArgs << Fn->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003509 << SourceRange(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
3510 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd());
3511 // This deletes the extra arguments.
Ted Kremenek8189cde2009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003512 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003513 return true;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003514 }
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003515 }
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003516 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> AllArgs;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003517 VariadicCallType CallType =
Fariborz Jahanian4cd1c702009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003518 Proto->isVariadic() ? VariadicFunction : VariadicDoesNotApply;
3519 if (Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType())
3520 CallType = VariadicBlock; // Block
3521 else if (isa<MemberExpr>(Fn))
3522 CallType = VariadicMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003523 Invalid = GatherArgumentsForCall(Call->getSourceRange().getBegin(), FDecl,
Fariborz Jahanian2fe168f2009-11-24 21:37:28 +00003524 Proto, 0, Args, NumArgs, AllArgs, CallType);
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003525 if (Invalid)
3526 return true;
3527 unsigned TotalNumArgs = AllArgs.size();
3528 for (unsigned i = 0; i < TotalNumArgs; ++i)
3529 Call->setArg(i, AllArgs[i]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003530
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003531 return false;
3532}
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003533
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003534bool Sema::GatherArgumentsForCall(SourceLocation CallLoc,
3535 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
3536 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
3537 unsigned FirstProtoArg,
3538 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3539 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> &AllArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian4cd1c702009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003540 VariadicCallType CallType) {
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003541 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
3542 unsigned NumArgsToCheck = NumArgs;
3543 bool Invalid = false;
3544 if (NumArgs != NumArgsInProto)
3545 // Use default arguments for missing arguments
3546 NumArgsToCheck = NumArgsInProto;
3547 unsigned ArgIx = 0;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003548 // Continue to check argument types (even if we have too few/many args).
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003549 for (unsigned i = FirstProtoArg; i != NumArgsToCheck; i++) {
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003550 QualType ProtoArgType = Proto->getArgType(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003551
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003552 Expr *Arg;
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003553 if (ArgIx < NumArgs) {
3554 Arg = Args[ArgIx++];
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003555
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003556 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3557 ProtoArgType,
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003558 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003559 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003560 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003561
Douglas Gregora188ff22009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003562 // Pass the argument
3563 ParmVarDecl *Param = 0;
3564 if (FDecl && i < FDecl->getNumParams())
3565 Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Douglas Gregoraa037312009-12-22 07:24:36 +00003566
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003567
Douglas Gregora188ff22009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003568 InitializedEntity Entity =
3569 Param? InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Param)
3570 : InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(ProtoArgType);
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003571 ExprResult ArgE = PerformCopyInitialization(Entity,
Douglas Gregora188ff22009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003572 SourceLocation(),
3573 Owned(Arg));
3574 if (ArgE.isInvalid())
3575 return true;
3576
3577 Arg = ArgE.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson5e300d12009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003578 } else {
Anders Carlssoned961f92009-08-25 02:29:20 +00003579 ParmVarDecl *Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003580
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003581 ExprResult ArgExpr =
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003582 BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(CallLoc, FDecl, Param);
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003583 if (ArgExpr.isInvalid())
3584 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003585
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003586 Arg = ArgExpr.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson5e300d12009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003587 }
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003588 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003589 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003590
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003591 // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...".
Fariborz Jahanian4cd1c702009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003592 if (CallType != VariadicDoesNotApply) {
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003593 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p7).
Chris Lattner40378332010-05-16 04:01:30 +00003594 for (unsigned i = ArgIx; i != NumArgs; ++i) {
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003595 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
Chris Lattner40378332010-05-16 04:01:30 +00003596 Invalid |= DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Arg, CallType, FDecl);
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003597 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003598 }
3599 }
Douglas Gregor3fd56d72009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003600 return Invalid;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003601}
3602
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003603/// ActOnCallExpr - Handle a call to Fn with the specified array of arguments.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00003604/// This provides the location of the left/right parens and a list of comma
3605/// locations.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003606ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003607Sema::ActOnCallExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Fn, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
Douglas Gregora1a04782010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003608 MultiExprArg args, SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003609 unsigned NumArgs = args.size();
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003610
3611 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003612 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Fn);
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003613 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
3614 Fn = Result.take();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003615
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003616 Expr **Args = args.release();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003617
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003618 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003619 // If this is a pseudo-destructor expression, build the call immediately.
3620 if (isa<CXXPseudoDestructorExpr>(Fn)) {
3621 if (NumArgs > 0) {
3622 // Pseudo-destructor calls should not have any arguments.
3623 Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), diag::err_pseudo_dtor_call_with_args)
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003624 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003625 SourceRange(Args[0]->getLocStart(),
3626 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd()));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003627
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003628 NumArgs = 0;
3629 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003630
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003631 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, 0, 0, Context.VoidTy,
3632 RParenLoc));
3633 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003634
Douglas Gregor17330012009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003635 // Determine whether this is a dependent call inside a C++ template,
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003636 // in which case we won't do any semantic analysis now.
Mike Stump390b4cc2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00003637 // FIXME: Will need to cache the results of name lookup (including ADL) in
3638 // Fn.
Douglas Gregor17330012009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003639 bool Dependent = false;
3640 if (Fn->isTypeDependent())
3641 Dependent = true;
3642 else if (Expr::hasAnyTypeDependentArguments(Args, NumArgs))
3643 Dependent = true;
3644
3645 if (Dependent)
Ted Kremenek668bf912009-02-09 20:51:47 +00003646 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor17330012009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003647 Context.DependentTy, RParenLoc));
3648
3649 // Determine whether this is a call to an object (C++ [over.call.object]).
3650 if (Fn->getType()->isRecordType())
3651 return Owned(BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregora1a04782010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003652 RParenLoc));
Douglas Gregor17330012009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003653
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003654 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
3655
3656 // Determine whether this is a call to an unresolved member function.
3657 if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
3658 // If lookup was unresolved but not dependent (i.e. didn't find
3659 // an unresolved using declaration), it has to be an overloaded
3660 // function set, which means it must contain either multiple
3661 // declarations (all methods or method templates) or a single
3662 // method template.
3663 assert((MemE->getNumDecls() > 1) ||
Douglas Gregor2b147f02010-04-25 21:15:30 +00003664 isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(
3665 (*MemE->decls_begin())->getUnderlyingDecl()));
Douglas Gregor958aeb02009-12-01 03:34:29 +00003666 (void)MemE;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003667
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003668 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregora1a04782010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003669 RParenLoc);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003670 }
3671
Douglas Gregorfa047642009-02-04 00:32:51 +00003672 // Determine whether this is a call to a member function.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003673 if (MemberExpr *MemExpr = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003674 NamedDecl *MemDecl = MemExpr->getMemberDecl();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003675 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(MemDecl))
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003676 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregora1a04782010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003677 RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003678 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003679
Anders Carlsson83ccfc32009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003680 // Determine whether this is a call to a pointer-to-member function.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003681 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NakedFn)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003682 if (BO->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemD ||
3683 BO->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemI) {
Douglas Gregor5f970ee2010-05-04 18:18:31 +00003684 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT
3685 = BO->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
Douglas Gregor5291c3c2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003686 QualType ResultTy = FPT->getCallResultType(Context);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003687
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003688 CXXMemberCallExpr *TheCall
3689 = new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, BO, Args,
3690 NumArgs, ResultTy,
3691 RParenLoc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003692
3693 if (CheckCallReturnType(FPT->getResultType(),
3694 BO->getRHS()->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003695 TheCall, 0))
Fariborz Jahanian5de24502009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003696 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson8d6d90d2009-10-15 00:41:48 +00003697
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003698 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, BO, 0, FPT, Args, NumArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian5de24502009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003699 RParenLoc))
3700 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson83ccfc32009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003701
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003702 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Fariborz Jahanian5de24502009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003703 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003704 return ExprError(Diag(Fn->getLocStart(),
Fariborz Jahanian5de24502009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003705 diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3706 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
Anders Carlsson83ccfc32009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003707 }
3708 }
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003709 }
3710
Douglas Gregorfa047642009-02-04 00:32:51 +00003711 // If we're directly calling a function, get the appropriate declaration.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003712 // Also, in C++, keep track of whether we should perform argument-dependent
Douglas Gregor6db8ed42009-06-30 23:57:56 +00003713 // lookup and whether there were any explicitly-specified template arguments.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003714
Eli Friedmanefa42f72009-12-26 03:35:45 +00003715 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003716 if (isa<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn)) {
3717 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn);
Douglas Gregor1aae80b2010-04-14 20:27:54 +00003718 return BuildOverloadedCallExpr(S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregora1a04782010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003719 RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003720 }
Chris Lattner04421082008-04-08 04:40:51 +00003721
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003722 NamedDecl *NDecl = 0;
3723 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn))
3724 NDecl = cast<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn)->getDecl();
3725
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003726 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc);
3727}
3728
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003729/// BuildResolvedCallExpr - Build a call to a resolved expression,
3730/// i.e. an expression not of \p OverloadTy. The expression should
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003731/// unary-convert to an expression of function-pointer or
3732/// block-pointer type.
3733///
3734/// \param NDecl the declaration being called, if available
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003735ExprResult
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003736Sema::BuildResolvedCallExpr(Expr *Fn, NamedDecl *NDecl,
3737 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
3738 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3739 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
3740 FunctionDecl *FDecl = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(NDecl);
3741
Chris Lattner04421082008-04-08 04:40:51 +00003742 // Promote the function operand.
3743 UsualUnaryConversions(Fn);
3744
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003745 // Make the call expr early, before semantic checks. This guarantees cleanup
3746 // of arguments and function on error.
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003747 CallExpr *TheCall = new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn,
3748 Args, NumArgs,
3749 Context.BoolTy,
3750 RParenLoc);
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003751
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003752 const FunctionType *FuncT;
3753 if (!Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()) {
3754 // C99 6.5.2.2p1 - "The expression that denotes the called function shall
3755 // have type pointer to function".
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003756 const PointerType *PT = Fn->getType()->getAs<PointerType>();
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003757 if (PT == 0)
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003758 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3759 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003760 FuncT = PT->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003761 } else { // This is a block call.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003762 FuncT = Fn->getType()->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003763 getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003764 }
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003765 if (FuncT == 0)
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003766 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3767 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
3768
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003769 // Check for a valid return type
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003770 if (CheckCallReturnType(FuncT->getResultType(),
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003771 Fn->getSourceRange().getBegin(), TheCall,
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00003772 FDecl))
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003773 return ExprError();
3774
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003775 // We know the result type of the call, set it.
Douglas Gregor5291c3c2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003776 TheCall->setType(FuncT->getCallResultType(Context));
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003777
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003778 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FuncT)) {
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003779 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, Fn, FDecl, Proto, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003780 RParenLoc))
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003781 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003782 } else {
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003783 assert(isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FuncT) && "Unknown FunctionType!");
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003784
Douglas Gregor74734d52009-04-02 15:37:10 +00003785 if (FDecl) {
3786 // Check if we have too few/too many template arguments, based
3787 // on our knowledge of the function definition.
3788 const FunctionDecl *Def = 0;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis06a54a32010-07-07 11:31:19 +00003789 if (FDecl->hasBody(Def) && NumArgs != Def->param_size()) {
Eli Friedmanbc4e29f2009-06-01 09:24:59 +00003790 const FunctionProtoType *Proto =
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003791 Def->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Eli Friedmanbc4e29f2009-06-01 09:24:59 +00003792 if (!Proto || !(Proto->isVariadic() && NumArgs >= Def->param_size())) {
3793 Diag(RParenLoc, diag::warn_call_wrong_number_of_arguments)
3794 << (NumArgs > Def->param_size()) << FDecl << Fn->getSourceRange();
3795 }
3796 }
Douglas Gregor74734d52009-04-02 15:37:10 +00003797 }
3798
Steve Naroffb291ab62007-08-28 23:30:39 +00003799 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p6).
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003800 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs; i++) {
3801 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
3802 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Arg);
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003803 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3804 Arg->getType(),
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003805 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
3806 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003807 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003808 TheCall->setArg(i, Arg);
Steve Naroffb291ab62007-08-28 23:30:39 +00003809 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00003810 }
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003811
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003812 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(FDecl))
3813 if (!Method->isStatic())
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003814 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_member_call_without_object)
3815 << Fn->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003816
Fariborz Jahaniandaf04152009-05-15 20:33:25 +00003817 // Check for sentinels
3818 if (NDecl)
3819 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003820
Chris Lattner59907c42007-08-10 20:18:51 +00003821 // Do special checking on direct calls to functions.
Anders Carlssond406bf02009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003822 if (FDecl) {
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003823 if (CheckFunctionCall(FDecl, TheCall))
Anders Carlssond406bf02009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003824 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003825
Douglas Gregor7814e6d2009-09-12 00:22:50 +00003826 if (unsigned BuiltinID = FDecl->getBuiltinID())
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003827 return CheckBuiltinFunctionCall(BuiltinID, TheCall);
Anders Carlssond406bf02009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003828 } else if (NDecl) {
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003829 if (CheckBlockCall(NDecl, TheCall))
Anders Carlssond406bf02009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003830 return ExprError();
3831 }
Chris Lattner59907c42007-08-10 20:18:51 +00003832
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003833 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00003834}
3835
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003836ExprResult
John McCallb3d87482010-08-24 05:47:05 +00003837Sema::ActOnCompoundLiteral(SourceLocation LParenLoc, ParsedType Ty,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003838 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *InitExpr) {
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003839 assert((Ty != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing type");
Steve Naroffaff1edd2007-07-19 21:32:11 +00003840 // FIXME: put back this assert when initializers are worked out.
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003841 //assert((InitExpr != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing expression");
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003842
3843 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
3844 QualType literalType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &TInfo);
3845 if (!TInfo)
3846 TInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(literalType);
3847
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003848 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, InitExpr);
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003849}
3850
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003851ExprResult
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003852Sema::BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003853 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *literalExpr) {
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003854 QualType literalType = TInfo->getType();
Anders Carlssond35c8322007-12-05 07:24:19 +00003855
Eli Friedman6223c222008-05-20 05:22:08 +00003856 if (literalType->isArrayType()) {
Chris Lattnerc63a1f22008-08-04 07:31:14 +00003857 if (literalType->isVariableArrayType())
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003858 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_variable_object_no_init)
3859 << SourceRange(LParenLoc, literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd()));
Douglas Gregor690dc7f2009-05-21 23:48:18 +00003860 } else if (!literalType->isDependentType() &&
3861 RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, literalType,
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003862 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003863 << SourceRange(LParenLoc,
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003864 literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd())))
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003865 return ExprError();
Eli Friedman6223c222008-05-20 05:22:08 +00003866
Douglas Gregor99a2e602009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003867 InitializedEntity Entity
Douglas Gregord6542d82009-12-22 15:35:07 +00003868 = InitializedEntity::InitializeTemporary(literalType);
Douglas Gregor99a2e602009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003869 InitializationKind Kind
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003870 = InitializationKind::CreateCast(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc),
Douglas Gregor99a2e602009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003871 /*IsCStyleCast=*/true);
Eli Friedman08544622009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003872 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &literalExpr, 1);
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003873 ExprResult Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
John McCallca0408f2010-08-23 06:44:23 +00003874 MultiExprArg(*this, &literalExpr, 1),
Eli Friedman08544622009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003875 &literalType);
3876 if (Result.isInvalid())
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003877 return ExprError();
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003878 literalExpr = Result.get();
Steve Naroffe9b12192008-01-14 18:19:28 +00003879
Chris Lattner371f2582008-12-04 23:50:19 +00003880 bool isFileScope = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0;
Steve Naroffe9b12192008-01-14 18:19:28 +00003881 if (isFileScope) { // 6.5.2.5p3
Steve Naroffd0091aa2008-01-10 22:15:12 +00003882 if (CheckForConstantInitializer(literalExpr, literalType))
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003883 return ExprError();
Steve Naroffd0091aa2008-01-10 22:15:12 +00003884 }
Eli Friedman08544622009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003885
John McCall1d7d8d62010-01-19 22:33:45 +00003886 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, literalType,
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00003887 literalExpr, isFileScope));
Steve Naroff4aa88f82007-07-19 01:06:55 +00003888}
3889
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003890ExprResult
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003891Sema::ActOnInitList(SourceLocation LBraceLoc, MultiExprArg initlist,
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003892 SourceLocation RBraceLoc) {
3893 unsigned NumInit = initlist.size();
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003894 Expr **InitList = initlist.release();
Anders Carlsson66b5a8a2007-08-31 04:56:16 +00003895
Steve Naroff08d92e42007-09-15 18:49:24 +00003896 // Semantic analysis for initializers is done by ActOnDeclarator() and
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003897 // CheckInitializer() - it requires knowledge of the object being intialized.
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003898
Ted Kremenek709210f2010-04-13 23:39:13 +00003899 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LBraceLoc, InitList,
3900 NumInit, RBraceLoc);
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00003901 E->setType(Context.VoidTy); // FIXME: just a place holder for now.
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003902 return Owned(E);
Steve Naroff4aa88f82007-07-19 01:06:55 +00003903}
3904
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003905static CastKind getScalarCastKind(ASTContext &Context,
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003906 QualType SrcTy, QualType DestTy) {
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003907 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(SrcTy, DestTy))
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003908 return CK_NoOp;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003909
3910 if (SrcTy->hasPointerRepresentation()) {
3911 if (DestTy->hasPointerRepresentation())
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003912 return DestTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() ?
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003913 CK_AnyPointerToObjCPointerCast :
3914 CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003915 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003916 return CK_PointerToIntegral;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003917 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003918
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003919 if (SrcTy->isIntegerType()) {
3920 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003921 return CK_IntegralCast;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003922 if (DestTy->hasPointerRepresentation())
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003923 return CK_IntegralToPointer;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003924 if (DestTy->isRealFloatingType())
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003925 return CK_IntegralToFloating;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003926 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003927
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003928 if (SrcTy->isRealFloatingType()) {
3929 if (DestTy->isRealFloatingType())
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003930 return CK_FloatingCast;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003931 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003932 return CK_FloatingToIntegral;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003933 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003934
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003935 // FIXME: Assert here.
3936 // assert(false && "Unhandled cast combination!");
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003937 return CK_Unknown;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003938}
3939
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003940/// CheckCastTypes - Check type constraints for casting between types.
Sebastian Redlef0cb8e2009-07-29 13:50:23 +00003941bool Sema::CheckCastTypes(SourceRange TyR, QualType castType, Expr *&castExpr,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003942 CastKind& Kind,
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00003943 CXXCastPath &BasePath,
Fariborz Jahaniane9f42082009-08-26 18:55:36 +00003944 bool FunctionalStyle) {
Sebastian Redl9cc11e72009-07-25 15:41:38 +00003945 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Anders Carlsson5cf86ba2010-04-24 19:06:50 +00003946 return CXXCheckCStyleCast(TyR, castType, castExpr, Kind, BasePath,
3947 FunctionalStyle);
Sebastian Redl9cc11e72009-07-25 15:41:38 +00003948
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00003949 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(castExpr);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003950
3951 // C99 6.5.4p2: the cast type needs to be void or scalar and the expression
3952 // type needs to be scalar.
3953 if (castType->isVoidType()) {
3954 // Cast to void allows any expr type.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003955 Kind = CK_ToVoid;
Anders Carlssonebeaf202009-10-16 02:35:04 +00003956 return false;
3957 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003958
Eli Friedman8d438082010-07-17 20:43:49 +00003959 if (RequireCompleteType(TyR.getBegin(), castType,
3960 diag::err_typecheck_cast_to_incomplete))
3961 return true;
3962
Anders Carlssonebeaf202009-10-16 02:35:04 +00003963 if (!castType->isScalarType() && !castType->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003964 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(castType, castExpr->getType()) &&
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003965 (castType->isStructureType() || castType->isUnionType())) {
3966 // GCC struct/union extension: allow cast to self.
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00003967 // FIXME: Check that the cast destination type is complete.
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003968 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_nonscalar)
3969 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003970 Kind = CK_NoOp;
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003971 return false;
3972 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003973
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003974 if (castType->isUnionType()) {
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003975 // GCC cast to union extension
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003976 RecordDecl *RD = castType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl();
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003977 RecordDecl::field_iterator Field, FieldEnd;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis17945a02009-06-30 02:36:12 +00003978 for (Field = RD->field_begin(), FieldEnd = RD->field_end();
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003979 Field != FieldEnd; ++Field) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003980 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Field->getType(),
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003981 castExpr->getType())) {
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003982 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_to_union)
3983 << castExpr->getSourceRange();
3984 break;
3985 }
3986 }
3987 if (Field == FieldEnd)
3988 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cast_to_union_no_type)
3989 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003990 Kind = CK_ToUnion;
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003991 return false;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003992 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003993
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003994 // Reject any other conversions to non-scalar types.
3995 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
3996 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
3997 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003998
3999 if (!castExpr->getType()->isScalarType() &&
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004000 !castExpr->getType()->isVectorType()) {
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004001 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
4002 diag::err_typecheck_expect_scalar_operand)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004003 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004004 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004005
4006 if (castType->isExtVectorType())
Anders Carlsson16a89042009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004007 return CheckExtVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr, Kind);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004008
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004009 if (castType->isVectorType())
4010 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr->getType(), Kind);
4011 if (castExpr->getType()->isVectorType())
4012 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castExpr->getType(), castType, Kind);
4013
Anders Carlsson16a89042009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004014 if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(castExpr))
4015 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_cast_selector_expr);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004016
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004017 if (!castType->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedman41826bb2009-05-01 02:23:58 +00004018 QualType castExprType = castExpr->getType();
Douglas Gregor9d3347a2010-06-16 00:35:25 +00004019 if (!castExprType->isIntegralType(Context) &&
Douglas Gregor2ade35e2010-06-16 00:17:44 +00004020 castExprType->isArithmeticType())
Eli Friedman41826bb2009-05-01 02:23:58 +00004021 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
4022 diag::err_cast_pointer_from_non_pointer_int)
4023 << castExprType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
4024 } else if (!castExpr->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
Douglas Gregor9d3347a2010-06-16 00:35:25 +00004025 if (!castType->isIntegralType(Context) && castType->isArithmeticType())
Eli Friedman41826bb2009-05-01 02:23:58 +00004026 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
4027 diag::err_cast_pointer_to_non_pointer_int)
4028 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00004029 }
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004030
4031 Kind = getScalarCastKind(Context, castExpr->getType(), castType);
John McCallb7f4ffe2010-08-12 21:44:57 +00004032
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004033 if (Kind == CK_Unknown || Kind == CK_BitCast)
John McCallb7f4ffe2010-08-12 21:44:57 +00004034 CheckCastAlign(castExpr, castType, TyR);
4035
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00004036 return false;
4037}
4038
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004039bool Sema::CheckVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType VectorTy, QualType Ty,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004040 CastKind &Kind) {
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004041 assert(VectorTy->isVectorType() && "Not a vector type!");
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004042
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004043 if (Ty->isVectorType() || Ty->isIntegerType()) {
Chris Lattner98be4942008-03-05 18:54:05 +00004044 if (Context.getTypeSize(VectorTy) != Context.getTypeSize(Ty))
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004045 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004046 Ty->isVectorType() ?
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004047 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vectors :
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004048 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_integer)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004049 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004050 } else
4051 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004052 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004053 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004054
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004055 Kind = CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004056 return false;
4057}
4058
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004059bool Sema::CheckExtVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType DestTy, Expr *&CastExpr,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004060 CastKind &Kind) {
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004061 assert(DestTy->isExtVectorType() && "Not an extended vector type!");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004062
Anders Carlsson16a89042009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004063 QualType SrcTy = CastExpr->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004064
Nate Begeman9b10da62009-06-27 22:05:55 +00004065 // If SrcTy is a VectorType, the total size must match to explicitly cast to
4066 // an ExtVectorType.
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004067 if (SrcTy->isVectorType()) {
4068 if (Context.getTypeSize(DestTy) != Context.getTypeSize(SrcTy))
4069 return Diag(R.getBegin(),diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_ext_vectors)
4070 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004071 Kind = CK_BitCast;
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004072 return false;
4073 }
4074
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004075 // All non-pointer scalars can be cast to ExtVector type. The appropriate
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004076 // conversion will take place first from scalar to elt type, and then
4077 // splat from elt type to vector.
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004078 if (SrcTy->isPointerType())
4079 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
4080 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
4081 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004082
4083 QualType DestElemTy = DestTy->getAs<ExtVectorType>()->getElementType();
4084 ImpCastExprToType(CastExpr, DestElemTy,
4085 getScalarCastKind(Context, SrcTy, DestElemTy));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004086
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004087 Kind = CK_VectorSplat;
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004088 return false;
4089}
4090
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004091ExprResult
John McCallb3d87482010-08-24 05:47:05 +00004092Sema::ActOnCastExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc, ParsedType Ty,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004093 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *castExpr) {
4094 assert((Ty != 0) && (castExpr != 0) &&
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004095 "ActOnCastExpr(): missing type or expr");
Steve Naroff16beff82007-07-16 23:25:18 +00004096
John McCall9d125032010-01-15 18:39:57 +00004097 TypeSourceInfo *castTInfo;
4098 QualType castType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &castTInfo);
4099 if (!castTInfo)
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004100 castTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(castType);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004101
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004102 // If the Expr being casted is a ParenListExpr, handle it specially.
4103 if (isa<ParenListExpr>(castExpr))
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004104 return ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(S, LParenLoc, RParenLoc, castExpr,
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004105 castTInfo);
John McCallb042fdf2010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004106
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004107 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, castTInfo, RParenLoc, castExpr);
John McCallb042fdf2010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004108}
4109
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004110ExprResult
John McCallb042fdf2010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004111Sema::BuildCStyleCastExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *Ty,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004112 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *castExpr) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004113 CastKind Kind = CK_Unknown;
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004114 CXXCastPath BasePath;
John McCallb042fdf2010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004115 if (CheckCastTypes(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc), Ty->getType(), castExpr,
Anders Carlsson5cf86ba2010-04-24 19:06:50 +00004116 Kind, BasePath))
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004117 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson0aebc812009-09-09 21:33:21 +00004118
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004119 return Owned(CStyleCastExpr::Create(Context,
Douglas Gregor63982352010-07-13 18:40:04 +00004120 Ty->getType().getNonLValueExprType(Context),
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004121 Kind, castExpr, &BasePath, Ty,
4122 LParenLoc, RParenLoc));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004123}
4124
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004125/// This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a sequence
4126/// of comma binary operators.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004127ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004128Sema::MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(Scope *S, Expr *expr) {
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004129 ParenListExpr *E = dyn_cast<ParenListExpr>(expr);
4130 if (!E)
4131 return Owned(expr);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004132
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004133 ExprResult Result(E->getExpr(0));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004134
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004135 for (unsigned i = 1, e = E->getNumExprs(); i != e && !Result.isInvalid(); ++i)
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004136 Result = ActOnBinOp(S, E->getExprLoc(), tok::comma, Result.get(),
4137 E->getExpr(i));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004138
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004139 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
4140
4141 return ActOnParenExpr(E->getLParenLoc(), E->getRParenLoc(), Result.get());
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004142}
4143
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004144ExprResult
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004145Sema::ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004146 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *Op,
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004147 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo) {
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004148 ParenListExpr *PE = cast<ParenListExpr>(Op);
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004149 QualType Ty = TInfo->getType();
John Thompson8bb59a82010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004150 bool isAltiVecLiteral = false;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004151
John Thompson8bb59a82010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004152 // Check for an altivec literal,
4153 // i.e. all the elements are integer constants.
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004154 if (getLangOptions().AltiVec && Ty->isVectorType()) {
4155 if (PE->getNumExprs() == 0) {
4156 Diag(PE->getExprLoc(), diag::err_altivec_empty_initializer);
4157 return ExprError();
4158 }
John Thompson8bb59a82010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004159 if (PE->getNumExprs() == 1) {
4160 if (!PE->getExpr(0)->getType()->isVectorType())
4161 isAltiVecLiteral = true;
4162 }
4163 else
4164 isAltiVecLiteral = true;
4165 }
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004166
John Thompson8bb59a82010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004167 // If this is an altivec initializer, '(' type ')' '(' init, ..., init ')'
4168 // then handle it as such.
4169 if (isAltiVecLiteral) {
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004170 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> initExprs;
4171 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PE->getNumExprs(); i != e; ++i)
4172 initExprs.push_back(PE->getExpr(i));
4173
4174 // FIXME: This means that pretty-printing the final AST will produce curly
4175 // braces instead of the original commas.
Ted Kremenek709210f2010-04-13 23:39:13 +00004176 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LParenLoc,
4177 &initExprs[0],
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004178 initExprs.size(), RParenLoc);
4179 E->setType(Ty);
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004180 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, E);
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004181 } else {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004182 // This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004183 // sequence of BinOp comma operators.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004184 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Op);
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004185 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
4186 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, Result.take());
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004187 }
4188}
4189
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004190ExprResult Sema::ActOnParenOrParenListExpr(SourceLocation L,
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004191 SourceLocation R,
Fariborz Jahanianf88f7ab2009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004192 MultiExprArg Val,
John McCallb3d87482010-08-24 05:47:05 +00004193 ParsedType TypeOfCast) {
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004194 unsigned nexprs = Val.size();
4195 Expr **exprs = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(Val.release());
Fariborz Jahanianf88f7ab2009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004196 assert((exprs != 0) && "ActOnParenOrParenListExpr() missing expr list");
4197 Expr *expr;
4198 if (nexprs == 1 && TypeOfCast && !TypeIsVectorType(TypeOfCast))
4199 expr = new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, exprs[0]);
4200 else
4201 expr = new (Context) ParenListExpr(Context, L, exprs, nexprs, R);
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004202 return Owned(expr);
4203}
4204
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00004205/// Note that lhs is not null here, even if this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension.
4206/// In that case, lhs = cond.
Chris Lattnera119a3b2009-02-18 04:38:20 +00004207/// C99 6.5.15
4208QualType Sema::CheckConditionalOperands(Expr *&Cond, Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
Fariborz Jahanian1fb019b2010-09-18 19:38:38 +00004209 Expr *&SAVE,
Chris Lattnera119a3b2009-02-18 04:38:20 +00004210 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
Sebastian Redl3201f6b2009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004211 // C++ is sufficiently different to merit its own checker.
4212 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Fariborz Jahanian1fb019b2010-09-18 19:38:38 +00004213 return CXXCheckConditionalOperands(Cond, LHS, RHS, SAVE, QuestionLoc);
Sebastian Redl3201f6b2009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004214
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004215 UsualUnaryConversions(Cond);
Fariborz Jahanian1fb019b2010-09-18 19:38:38 +00004216 if (SAVE) {
4217 SAVE = LHS = Cond;
4218 }
4219 else
4220 UsualUnaryConversions(LHS);
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004221 UsualUnaryConversions(RHS);
4222 QualType CondTy = Cond->getType();
4223 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
4224 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00004225
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004226 // first, check the condition.
Sebastian Redl3201f6b2009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004227 if (!CondTy->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.5.15p2
Nate Begeman6155d732010-09-20 22:41:17 +00004228 // OpenCL: Sec 6.3.i says the condition is allowed to be a vector or scalar.
4229 // Throw an error if its not either.
4230 if (getLangOptions().OpenCL) {
4231 if (!CondTy->isVectorType()) {
4232 Diag(Cond->getLocStart(),
4233 diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar_or_vector)
4234 << CondTy;
4235 return QualType();
4236 }
4237 }
4238 else {
4239 Diag(Cond->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4240 << CondTy;
4241 return QualType();
4242 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004243 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004244
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004245 // Now check the two expressions.
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004246 if (LHSTy->isVectorType() || RHSTy->isVectorType())
4247 return CheckVectorOperands(QuestionLoc, LHS, RHS);
Douglas Gregor898574e2008-12-05 23:32:09 +00004248
Nate Begeman6155d732010-09-20 22:41:17 +00004249 // OpenCL: If the condition is a vector, and both operands are scalar,
4250 // attempt to implicity convert them to the vector type to act like the
4251 // built in select.
4252 if (getLangOptions().OpenCL && CondTy->isVectorType()) {
4253 // Both operands should be of scalar type.
4254 if (!LHSTy->isScalarType()) {
4255 Diag(LHS->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4256 << CondTy;
4257 return QualType();
4258 }
4259 if (!RHSTy->isScalarType()) {
4260 Diag(RHS->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4261 << CondTy;
4262 return QualType();
4263 }
4264 // Implicity convert these scalars to the type of the condition.
4265 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, CondTy, CK_IntegralCast);
4266 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, CondTy, CK_IntegralCast);
4267 }
4268
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004269 // If both operands have arithmetic type, do the usual arithmetic conversions
4270 // to find a common type: C99 6.5.15p3,5.
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004271 if (LHSTy->isArithmeticType() && RHSTy->isArithmeticType()) {
4272 UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS);
4273 return LHS->getType();
Steve Naroffa4332e22007-07-17 00:58:39 +00004274 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004275
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004276 // If both operands are the same structure or union type, the result is that
4277 // type.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004278 if (const RecordType *LHSRT = LHSTy->getAs<RecordType>()) { // C99 6.5.15p3
4279 if (const RecordType *RHSRT = RHSTy->getAs<RecordType>())
Chris Lattnera21ddb32007-11-26 01:40:58 +00004280 if (LHSRT->getDecl() == RHSRT->getDecl())
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004281 // "If both the operands have structure or union type, the result has
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004282 // that type." This implies that CV qualifiers are dropped.
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004283 return LHSTy.getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00004284 // FIXME: Type of conditional expression must be complete in C mode.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004285 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004286
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004287 // C99 6.5.15p5: "If both operands have void type, the result has void type."
Steve Naroffe701c0a2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004288 // The following || allows only one side to be void (a GCC-ism).
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004289 if (LHSTy->isVoidType() || RHSTy->isVoidType()) {
4290 if (!LHSTy->isVoidType())
4291 Diag(RHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4292 << RHS->getSourceRange();
4293 if (!RHSTy->isVoidType())
4294 Diag(LHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4295 << LHS->getSourceRange();
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004296 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, Context.VoidTy, CK_ToVoid);
4297 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, Context.VoidTy, CK_ToVoid);
Eli Friedman0e724012008-06-04 19:47:51 +00004298 return Context.VoidTy;
Steve Naroffe701c0a2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004299 }
Steve Naroffb6d54e52008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004300 // C99 6.5.15p6 - "if one operand is a null pointer constant, the result has
4301 // the type of the other operand."
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004302 if ((LHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || LHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004303 RHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004304 // promote the null to a pointer.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004305 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_Unknown);
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004306 return LHSTy;
Steve Naroffb6d54e52008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004307 }
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004308 if ((RHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004309 LHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004310 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_Unknown);
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004311 return RHSTy;
Steve Naroffb6d54e52008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004312 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004313
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004314 // All objective-c pointer type analysis is done here.
4315 QualType compositeType = FindCompositeObjCPointerType(LHS, RHS,
4316 QuestionLoc);
4317 if (!compositeType.isNull())
4318 return compositeType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004319
4320
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004321 // Handle block pointer types.
4322 if (LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
4323 if (!LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || !RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
4324 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() || RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
4325 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004326 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
4327 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004328 return destType;
4329 }
4330 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004331 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004332 return QualType();
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004333 }
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004334 // We have 2 block pointer types.
4335 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4336 // Two identical block pointer types are always compatible.
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004337 return LHSTy;
4338 }
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004339 // The block pointer types aren't identical, continue checking.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004340 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4341 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004342
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004343 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
4344 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004345 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004346 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004347 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
4348 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
4349 // to get a consistent AST.
4350 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004351 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
4352 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004353 return incompatTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004354 }
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004355 // The block pointer types are compatible.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004356 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
4357 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff91588042009-04-08 17:05:15 +00004358 return LHSTy;
4359 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004360
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004361 // Check constraints for C object pointers types (C99 6.5.15p3,6).
4362 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isPointerType()) {
4363 // get the "pointed to" types
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004364 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4365 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004366
4367 // ignore qualifiers on void (C99 6.5.15p3, clause 6)
4368 if (lhptee->isVoidType() && rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
4369 // Figure out necessary qualifiers (C99 6.5.15p6)
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004370 QualType destPointee
4371 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004372 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004373 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004374 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004375 // Promote to void*.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004376 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004377 return destType;
4378 }
4379 if (rhptee->isVoidType() && lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004380 QualType destPointee
4381 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004382 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004383 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004384 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004385 // Promote to void*.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004386 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004387 return destType;
4388 }
4389
4390 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4391 // Two identical pointer types are always compatible.
4392 return LHSTy;
4393 }
4394 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
4395 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
4396 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
4397 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
4398 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
4399 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
4400 // to get a consistent AST.
4401 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004402 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
4403 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004404 return incompatTy;
4405 }
4406 // The pointer types are compatible.
4407 // C99 6.5.15p6: If both operands are pointers to compatible types *or* to
4408 // differently qualified versions of compatible types, the result type is
4409 // a pointer to an appropriately qualified version of the *composite*
4410 // type.
4411 // FIXME: Need to calculate the composite type.
4412 // FIXME: Need to add qualifiers
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004413 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
4414 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004415 return LHSTy;
4416 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004417
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004418 // GCC compatibility: soften pointer/integer mismatch.
4419 if (RHSTy->isPointerType() && LHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
4420 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
4421 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004422 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004423 return RHSTy;
4424 }
4425 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
4426 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
4427 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004428 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004429 return LHSTy;
4430 }
Daniel Dunbar5e155f02008-09-11 23:12:46 +00004431
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004432 // Otherwise, the operands are not compatible.
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004433 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
4434 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004435 return QualType();
4436}
4437
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004438/// FindCompositeObjCPointerType - Helper method to find composite type of
4439/// two objective-c pointer types of the two input expressions.
4440QualType Sema::FindCompositeObjCPointerType(Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
4441 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
4442 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
4443 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004444
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004445 // Handle things like Class and struct objc_class*. Here we case the result
4446 // to the pseudo-builtin, because that will be implicitly cast back to the
4447 // redefinition type if an attempt is made to access its fields.
4448 if (LHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
4449 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004450 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004451 return LHSTy;
4452 }
4453 if (RHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
4454 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004455 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004456 return RHSTy;
4457 }
4458 // And the same for struct objc_object* / id
4459 if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
4460 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004461 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004462 return LHSTy;
4463 }
4464 if (RHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
4465 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004466 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004467 return RHSTy;
4468 }
4469 // And the same for struct objc_selector* / SEL
4470 if (Context.isObjCSelType(LHSTy) &&
4471 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004472 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004473 return LHSTy;
4474 }
4475 if (Context.isObjCSelType(RHSTy) &&
4476 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004477 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004478 return RHSTy;
4479 }
4480 // Check constraints for Objective-C object pointers types.
4481 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004482
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004483 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4484 // Two identical object pointer types are always compatible.
4485 return LHSTy;
4486 }
4487 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4488 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4489 QualType compositeType = LHSTy;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004490
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004491 // If both operands are interfaces and either operand can be
4492 // assigned to the other, use that type as the composite
4493 // type. This allows
4494 // xxx ? (A*) a : (B*) b
4495 // where B is a subclass of A.
4496 //
4497 // Additionally, as for assignment, if either type is 'id'
4498 // allow silent coercion. Finally, if the types are
4499 // incompatible then make sure to use 'id' as the composite
4500 // type so the result is acceptable for sending messages to.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004501
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004502 // FIXME: Consider unifying with 'areComparableObjCPointerTypes'.
4503 // It could return the composite type.
4504 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)) {
4505 compositeType = RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? RHSTy : LHSTy;
4506 } else if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT, LHSOPT)) {
4507 compositeType = LHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? LHSTy : RHSTy;
4508 } else if ((LHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType() ||
4509 RHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) &&
4510 Context.ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(LHSTy, RHSTy, true)) {
4511 // Need to handle "id<xx>" explicitly.
4512 // GCC allows qualified id and any Objective-C type to devolve to
4513 // id. Currently localizing to here until clear this should be
4514 // part of ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible.
4515 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
4516 } else if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() || RHSTy->isObjCIdType()) {
4517 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004518 } else if (!(compositeType =
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004519 Context.areCommonBaseCompatible(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)).isNull())
4520 ;
4521 else {
4522 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
4523 << LHSTy << RHSTy
4524 << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
4525 QualType incompatTy = Context.getObjCIdType();
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004526 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
4527 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004528 return incompatTy;
4529 }
4530 // The object pointer types are compatible.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004531 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, compositeType, CK_BitCast);
4532 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, compositeType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004533 return compositeType;
4534 }
4535 // Check Objective-C object pointer types and 'void *'
4536 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
4537 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4538 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4539 QualType destPointee
4540 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
4541 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
4542 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004543 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004544 // Promote to void*.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004545 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004546 return destType;
4547 }
4548 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
4549 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4550 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4551 QualType destPointee
4552 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
4553 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
4554 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004555 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004556 // Promote to void*.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004557 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004558 return destType;
4559 }
4560 return QualType();
4561}
4562
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00004563/// ActOnConditionalOp - Parse a ?: operation. Note that 'LHS' may be null
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004564/// in the case of a the GNU conditional expr extension.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004565ExprResult Sema::ActOnConditionalOp(SourceLocation QuestionLoc,
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004566 SourceLocation ColonLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004567 Expr *CondExpr, Expr *LHSExpr,
4568 Expr *RHSExpr) {
Chris Lattnera21ddb32007-11-26 01:40:58 +00004569 // If this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension, analyze the types as though the LHS
4570 // was the condition.
4571 bool isLHSNull = LHSExpr == 0;
Fariborz Jahanianf9b949f2010-08-31 18:02:20 +00004572 Expr *SAVEExpr = 0;
4573 if (isLHSNull) {
4574 LHSExpr = SAVEExpr = CondExpr;
4575 }
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004576
Fariborz Jahanian1fb019b2010-09-18 19:38:38 +00004577 QualType result = CheckConditionalOperands(CondExpr, LHSExpr, RHSExpr,
4578 SAVEExpr, QuestionLoc);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004579 if (result.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004580 return ExprError();
4581
Douglas Gregor47e1f7c2009-08-26 14:37:04 +00004582 return Owned(new (Context) ConditionalOperator(CondExpr, QuestionLoc,
Fariborz Jahanianf9b949f2010-08-31 18:02:20 +00004583 LHSExpr, ColonLoc,
4584 RHSExpr, SAVEExpr,
4585 result));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004586}
4587
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004588// CheckPointerTypesForAssignment - This is a very tricky routine (despite
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004589// being closely modeled after the C99 spec:-). The odd characteristic of this
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004590// routine is it effectively iqnores the qualifiers on the top level pointee.
4591// This circumvents the usual type rules specified in 6.2.7p1 & 6.7.5.[1-3].
4592// FIXME: add a couple examples in this comment.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004593Sema::AssignConvertType
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004594Sema::CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
4595 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004596
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00004597 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4598 (rhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) ||
4599 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4600 (lhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
4601 return Compatible;
4602 }
4603
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004604 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004605 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4606 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004607
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004608 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004609 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4610 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004611
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004612 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004613
4614 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: This following citation is common to constraints
4615 // 3 & 4 (below). ...and the type *pointed to* by the left has all the
4616 // qualifiers of the type *pointed to* by the right;
Fariborz Jahanianf11284a2009-02-17 18:27:45 +00004617 // FIXME: Handle ExtQualType
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004618 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004619 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004620
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004621 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 4): If one operand is a pointer to an object or
4622 // incomplete type and the other is a pointer to a qualified or unqualified
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004623 // version of void...
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004624 if (lhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerd805bec2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004625 if (rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004626 return ConvTy;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004627
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004628 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerd805bec2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004629 assert(rhptee->isFunctionType());
4630 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004631 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004632
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004633 if (rhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerd805bec2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004634 if (lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004635 return ConvTy;
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004636
4637 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerd805bec2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004638 assert(lhptee->isFunctionType());
4639 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004640 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004641 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 3): both operands are pointers to qualified or
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004642 // unqualified versions of compatible types, ...
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004643 lhptee = lhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
4644 rhptee = rhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
4645 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee)) {
4646 // Check if the pointee types are compatible ignoring the sign.
4647 // We explicitly check for char so that we catch "char" vs
4648 // "unsigned char" on systems where "char" is unsigned.
Chris Lattner6a2b9262009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004649 if (lhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004650 lhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00004651 else if (lhptee->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation())
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004652 lhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(lhptee);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004653
Chris Lattner6a2b9262009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004654 if (rhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004655 rhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00004656 else if (rhptee->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation())
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004657 rhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(rhptee);
Chris Lattner6a2b9262009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004658
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004659 if (lhptee == rhptee) {
4660 // Types are compatible ignoring the sign. Qualifier incompatibility
4661 // takes priority over sign incompatibility because the sign
4662 // warning can be disabled.
4663 if (ConvTy != Compatible)
4664 return ConvTy;
4665 return IncompatiblePointerSign;
4666 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004667
Fariborz Jahanian36a862f2009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004668 // If we are a multi-level pointer, it's possible that our issue is simply
4669 // one of qualification - e.g. char ** -> const char ** is not allowed. If
4670 // the eventual target type is the same and the pointers have the same
4671 // level of indirection, this must be the issue.
4672 if (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType()) {
4673 do {
4674 lhptee = lhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4675 rhptee = rhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004676
Fariborz Jahanian36a862f2009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004677 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4678 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
4679 } while (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004680
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004681 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee))
Sean Huntc9132b62009-11-08 07:46:34 +00004682 return IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers;
Fariborz Jahanian36a862f2009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004683 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004684
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004685 // General pointer incompatibility takes priority over qualifiers.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004686 return IncompatiblePointer;
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004687 }
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004688 return ConvTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004689}
4690
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004691/// CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment - This routine determines whether two
4692/// block pointer types are compatible or whether a block and normal pointer
4693/// are compatible. It is more restrict than comparing two function pointer
4694// types.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004695Sema::AssignConvertType
4696Sema::CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType,
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004697 QualType rhsType) {
4698 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004699
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004700 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004701 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4702 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004703
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004704 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
4705 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4706 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004707
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004708 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004709
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004710 // For blocks we enforce that qualifiers are identical.
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004711 if (lhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers() != rhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers())
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004712 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004713
Fariborz Jahanian132f2a22010-03-17 00:20:01 +00004714 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
4715 if (!Context.typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
4716 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
4717 }
4718 else if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee))
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004719 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004720 return ConvTy;
4721}
4722
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004723/// CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment - Compares two objective-c pointer types
4724/// for assignment compatibility.
4725Sema::AssignConvertType
4726Sema::CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Fariborz Jahaniand4c60902010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004727 if (lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
4728 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian528adb12010-03-24 21:00:27 +00004729 if (lhsType->isObjCClassType() && !rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
4730 !rhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand4c60902010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004731 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004732 return Compatible;
Fariborz Jahaniand4c60902010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004733 }
4734 if (rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
4735 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian528adb12010-03-24 21:00:27 +00004736 if (rhsType->isObjCClassType() && !lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
4737 !lhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand4c60902010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004738 return IncompatiblePointer;
4739 return Compatible;
4740 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004741 QualType lhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004742 lhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004743 QualType rhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004744 rhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4745 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
4746 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4747 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
4748 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
4749 return CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004750
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004751 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
4752 return Compatible;
4753 if (lhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || rhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
4754 return IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004755 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004756}
4757
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004758/// CheckAssignmentConstraints (C99 6.5.16) - This routine currently
4759/// has code to accommodate several GCC extensions when type checking
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004760/// pointers. Here are some objectionable examples that GCC considers warnings:
4761///
4762/// int a, *pint;
4763/// short *pshort;
4764/// struct foo *pfoo;
4765///
4766/// pint = pshort; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
4767/// a = pint; // warning: assignment makes integer from pointer without a cast
4768/// pint = a; // warning: assignment makes pointer from integer without a cast
4769/// pint = pfoo; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
4770///
4771/// As a result, the code for dealing with pointers is more complex than the
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004772/// C99 spec dictates.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004773///
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004774Sema::AssignConvertType
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004775Sema::CheckAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004776 // Get canonical types. We're not formatting these types, just comparing
4777 // them.
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004778 lhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(lhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
4779 rhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(rhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004780
4781 if (lhsType == rhsType)
Chris Lattnerd2656dd2008-01-07 17:51:46 +00004782 return Compatible; // Common case: fast path an exact match.
Steve Naroff700204c2007-07-24 21:46:40 +00004783
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00004784 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4785 (rhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) ||
4786 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4787 (lhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
4788 return Compatible;
4789 }
4790
Douglas Gregor9d293df2008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004791 // If the left-hand side is a reference type, then we are in a
4792 // (rare!) case where we've allowed the use of references in C,
4793 // e.g., as a parameter type in a built-in function. In this case,
4794 // just make sure that the type referenced is compatible with the
4795 // right-hand side type. The caller is responsible for adjusting
4796 // lhsType so that the resulting expression does not have reference
4797 // type.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004798 if (const ReferenceType *lhsTypeRef = lhsType->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
Douglas Gregor9d293df2008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004799 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsTypeRef->getPointeeType(), rhsType))
Anders Carlsson793680e2007-10-12 23:56:29 +00004800 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004801 return Incompatible;
Fariborz Jahanian411f3732007-12-19 17:45:58 +00004802 }
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004803 // Allow scalar to ExtVector assignments, and assignments of an ExtVector type
4804 // to the same ExtVector type.
4805 if (lhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
4806 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType())
4807 return lhsType == rhsType ? Compatible : Incompatible;
Douglas Gregor00619622010-06-22 23:41:02 +00004808 if (rhsType->isArithmeticType())
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004809 return Compatible;
4810 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004811
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004812 if (lhsType->isVectorType() || rhsType->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregor255210e2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00004813 if (lhsType->isVectorType() && rhsType->isVectorType()) {
4814 // If we are allowing lax vector conversions, and LHS and RHS are both
4815 // vectors, the total size only needs to be the same. This is a bitcast;
4816 // no bits are changed but the result type is different.
4817 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions &&
4818 (Context.getTypeSize(lhsType) == Context.getTypeSize(rhsType)))
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00004819 return IncompatibleVectors;
Douglas Gregor255210e2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00004820
4821 // Allow assignments of an AltiVec vector type to an equivalent GCC
4822 // vector type and vice versa
4823 if (Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(lhsType, rhsType))
4824 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnere8b3e962008-01-04 23:32:24 +00004825 }
4826 return Incompatible;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004827 }
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004828
Douglas Gregor88623ad2010-05-23 21:53:47 +00004829 if (lhsType->isArithmeticType() && rhsType->isArithmeticType() &&
4830 !(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && lhsType->isEnumeralType()))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004831 return Compatible;
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004832
Chris Lattner78eca282008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004833 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004834 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattnerb7b61152008-01-04 18:22:42 +00004835 return IntToPointer;
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004836
Chris Lattner78eca282008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004837 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004838 return CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004839
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004840 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004841 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004842 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4843 return Compatible;
4844 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004845 }
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004846 if (rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
4847 if (lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregor63a94902008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004848 return Compatible;
Steve Naroffb4406862008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004849
4850 // Treat block pointers as objects.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004851 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && lhsType->isObjCIdType())
Steve Naroffb4406862008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004852 return Compatible;
4853 }
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004854 return Incompatible;
4855 }
4856
4857 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType)) {
4858 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
Eli Friedmand8f4f432009-02-25 04:20:42 +00004859 return IntToBlockPointer;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004860
Steve Naroffb4406862008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004861 // Treat block pointers as objects.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004862 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && rhsType->isObjCIdType())
Steve Naroffb4406862008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004863 return Compatible;
4864
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004865 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
4866 return CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004867
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004868 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004869 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregor63a94902008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004870 return Compatible;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004871 }
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004872 return Incompatible;
4873 }
4874
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004875 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(lhsType)) {
4876 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
4877 return IntToPointer;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004878
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004879 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004880 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004881 if (rhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4882 return Compatible;
4883 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004884 }
4885 if (rhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004886 return CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004887 }
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004888 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004889 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
4890 return Compatible;
4891 }
4892 // Treat block pointers as objects.
4893 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
4894 return Compatible;
4895 return Incompatible;
4896 }
Chris Lattner78eca282008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004897 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004898 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004899 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy)
4900 return Compatible;
4901
4902 if (lhsType->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattnerb7b61152008-01-04 18:22:42 +00004903 return PointerToInt;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004904
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004905 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004906 return CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004907
4908 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004909 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregor63a94902008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004910 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004911 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004912 }
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004913 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
4914 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
4915 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy)
4916 return Compatible;
4917
4918 if (lhsType->isIntegerType())
4919 return PointerToInt;
4920
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004921 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004922 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004923 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4924 return Compatible;
4925 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004926 }
4927 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004928 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004929 return Compatible;
4930 return Incompatible;
4931 }
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004932
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004933 if (isa<TagType>(lhsType) && isa<TagType>(rhsType)) {
Chris Lattner78eca282008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004934 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004935 return Compatible;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004936 }
4937 return Incompatible;
4938}
4939
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004940/// \brief Constructs a transparent union from an expression that is
4941/// used to initialize the transparent union.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004942static void ConstructTransparentUnion(ASTContext &C, Expr *&E,
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004943 QualType UnionType, FieldDecl *Field) {
4944 // Build an initializer list that designates the appropriate member
4945 // of the transparent union.
Ted Kremenek709210f2010-04-13 23:39:13 +00004946 InitListExpr *Initializer = new (C) InitListExpr(C, SourceLocation(),
Ted Kremenekba7bc552010-02-19 01:50:18 +00004947 &E, 1,
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004948 SourceLocation());
4949 Initializer->setType(UnionType);
4950 Initializer->setInitializedFieldInUnion(Field);
4951
4952 // Build a compound literal constructing a value of the transparent
4953 // union type from this initializer list.
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004954 TypeSourceInfo *unionTInfo = C.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(UnionType);
John McCall1d7d8d62010-01-19 22:33:45 +00004955 E = new (C) CompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation(), unionTInfo, UnionType,
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004956 Initializer, false);
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004957}
4958
4959Sema::AssignConvertType
4960Sema::CheckTransparentUnionArgumentConstraints(QualType ArgType, Expr *&rExpr) {
4961 QualType FromType = rExpr->getType();
4962
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004963 // If the ArgType is a Union type, we want to handle a potential
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004964 // transparent_union GCC extension.
4965 const RecordType *UT = ArgType->getAsUnionType();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40b598e2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00004966 if (!UT || !UT->getDecl()->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>())
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004967 return Incompatible;
4968
4969 // The field to initialize within the transparent union.
4970 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
4971 FieldDecl *InitField = 0;
4972 // It's compatible if the expression matches any of the fields.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis17945a02009-06-30 02:36:12 +00004973 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator it = UD->field_begin(),
4974 itend = UD->field_end();
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004975 it != itend; ++it) {
4976 if (it->getType()->isPointerType()) {
4977 // If the transparent union contains a pointer type, we allow:
4978 // 1) void pointer
4979 // 2) null pointer constant
4980 if (FromType->isPointerType())
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004981 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004982 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004983 InitField = *it;
4984 break;
4985 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004986
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004987 if (rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004988 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004989 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004990 InitField = *it;
4991 break;
4992 }
4993 }
4994
4995 if (CheckAssignmentConstraints(it->getType(), rExpr->getType())
4996 == Compatible) {
Daniel Dunbar41e11a92010-09-17 23:21:43 +00004997 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CK_Unknown);
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004998 InitField = *it;
4999 break;
5000 }
5001 }
5002
5003 if (!InitField)
5004 return Incompatible;
5005
5006 ConstructTransparentUnion(Context, rExpr, ArgType, InitField);
5007 return Compatible;
5008}
5009
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005010Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005011Sema::CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, Expr *&rExpr) {
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00005012 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5013 if (!lhsType->isRecordType()) {
5014 // C++ 5.17p3: If the left operand is not of class type, the
5015 // expression is implicitly converted (C++ 4) to the
5016 // cv-unqualified type of the left operand.
Douglas Gregor45920e82008-12-19 17:40:08 +00005017 if (PerformImplicitConversion(rExpr, lhsType.getUnqualifiedType(),
Douglas Gregor68647482009-12-16 03:45:30 +00005018 AA_Assigning))
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00005019 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattner2c4463f2009-04-12 09:02:39 +00005020 return Compatible;
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00005021 }
5022
5023 // FIXME: Currently, we fall through and treat C++ classes like C
5024 // structures.
5025 }
5026
Steve Naroff529a4ad2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00005027 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is a pointer and the right is
5028 // a null pointer constant.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005029 if ((lhsType->isPointerType() ||
5030 lhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005031 lhsType->isBlockPointerType())
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005032 && rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005033 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005034 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType, CK_Unknown);
Steve Naroff529a4ad2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00005035 return Compatible;
5036 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005037
Chris Lattner943140e2007-10-16 02:55:40 +00005038 // This check seems unnatural, however it is necessary to ensure the proper
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005039 // conversion of functions/arrays. If the conversion were done for all
Douglas Gregor02a24ee2009-11-03 16:56:39 +00005040 // DeclExpr's (created by ActOnIdExpression), it would mess up the unary
Nick Lewyckyc133e9e2010-08-05 06:27:49 +00005041 // expressions that suppress this implicit conversion (&, sizeof).
Chris Lattner943140e2007-10-16 02:55:40 +00005042 //
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005043 // Suppress this for references: C++ 8.5.3p5.
Chris Lattner943140e2007-10-16 02:55:40 +00005044 if (!lhsType->isReferenceType())
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00005045 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(rExpr);
Steve Narofff1120de2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00005046
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005047 Sema::AssignConvertType result =
5048 CheckAssignmentConstraints(lhsType, rExpr->getType());
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005049
Steve Narofff1120de2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00005050 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: The value of the right operand is converted to the
5051 // type of the assignment expression.
Douglas Gregor9d293df2008-10-28 00:22:11 +00005052 // CheckAssignmentConstraints allows the left-hand side to be a reference,
5053 // so that we can use references in built-in functions even in C.
5054 // The getNonReferenceType() call makes sure that the resulting expression
5055 // does not have reference type.
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005056 if (result != Incompatible && rExpr->getType() != lhsType)
Douglas Gregor63982352010-07-13 18:40:04 +00005057 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType.getNonLValueExprType(Context),
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005058 CK_Unknown);
Steve Narofff1120de2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00005059 return result;
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005060}
5061
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005062QualType Sema::InvalidOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005063 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_operands)
Chris Lattner22caddc2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00005064 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005065 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005066 return QualType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005067}
5068
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005069QualType Sema::CheckVectorOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005070 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Nate Begeman1330b0e2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00005071 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +00005072 QualType lhsType =
5073 Context.getCanonicalType(lex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
5074 QualType rhsType =
5075 Context.getCanonicalType(rex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005076
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005077 // If the vector types are identical, return.
Nate Begeman1330b0e2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00005078 if (lhsType == rhsType)
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005079 return lhsType;
Nate Begeman4119d1a2007-12-30 02:59:45 +00005080
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005081 // Handle the case of a vector & extvector type of the same size and element
5082 // type. It would be nice if we only had one vector type someday.
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005083 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions) {
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005084 if (const VectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<VectorType>()) {
Chandler Carruth629f9e42010-08-30 07:36:24 +00005085 if (const VectorType *RV = rhsType->getAs<VectorType>()) {
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005086 if (LV->getElementType() == RV->getElementType() &&
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005087 LV->getNumElements() == RV->getNumElements()) {
Douglas Gregor26bcf672010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005088 if (lhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005089 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor26bcf672010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005090 return lhsType;
5091 }
5092
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005093 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rhsType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor26bcf672010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005094 return rhsType;
Eric Christophere84f9eb2010-08-26 00:42:16 +00005095 } else if (Context.getTypeSize(lhsType) ==Context.getTypeSize(rhsType)){
5096 // If we are allowing lax vector conversions, and LHS and RHS are both
5097 // vectors, the total size only needs to be the same. This is a
5098 // bitcast; no bits are changed but the result type is different.
5099 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_BitCast);
5100 return lhsType;
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005101 }
Eric Christophere84f9eb2010-08-26 00:42:16 +00005102 }
Chandler Carruth629f9e42010-08-30 07:36:24 +00005103 }
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005104 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005105
Douglas Gregor255210e2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00005106 // Handle the case of equivalent AltiVec and GCC vector types
5107 if (lhsType->isVectorType() && rhsType->isVectorType() &&
5108 Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(lhsType, rhsType)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005109 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rhsType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor255210e2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00005110 return rhsType;
5111 }
5112
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005113 // Canonicalize the ExtVector to the LHS, remember if we swapped so we can
5114 // swap back (so that we don't reverse the inputs to a subtract, for instance.
5115 bool swapped = false;
5116 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
5117 swapped = true;
5118 std::swap(rex, lex);
5119 std::swap(rhsType, lhsType);
5120 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005121
Nate Begemandde25982009-06-28 19:12:57 +00005122 // Handle the case of an ext vector and scalar.
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005123 if (const ExtVectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<ExtVectorType>()) {
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005124 QualType EltTy = LV->getElementType();
Douglas Gregor9d3347a2010-06-16 00:35:25 +00005125 if (EltTy->isIntegralType(Context) && rhsType->isIntegralType(Context)) {
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005126 if (Context.getIntegerTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType) >= 0) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005127 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_IntegralCast);
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005128 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
5129 return lhsType;
5130 }
5131 }
5132 if (EltTy->isRealFloatingType() && rhsType->isScalarType() &&
5133 rhsType->isRealFloatingType()) {
5134 if (Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType) >= 0) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005135 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_FloatingCast);
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005136 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
5137 return lhsType;
5138 }
Nate Begeman4119d1a2007-12-30 02:59:45 +00005139 }
5140 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005141
Nate Begemandde25982009-06-28 19:12:57 +00005142 // Vectors of different size or scalar and non-ext-vector are errors.
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005143 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_vector_not_convertable)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005144 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005145 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005146 return QualType();
Sebastian Redl22460502009-02-07 00:15:38 +00005147}
5148
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005149QualType Sema::CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(
5150 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign, bool isDiv) {
Daniel Dunbar69d1d002009-01-05 22:42:10 +00005151 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005152 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005153
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005154 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005155
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005156 if (!lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() ||
5157 !rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
5158 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005159
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005160 // Check for division by zero.
5161 if (isDiv &&
5162 rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005163 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_division_by_zero)
Chris Lattnercb329c52010-01-12 21:30:55 +00005164 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005165
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005166 return compType;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005167}
5168
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005169QualType Sema::CheckRemainderOperands(
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005170 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Daniel Dunbar523aa602009-01-05 22:55:36 +00005171 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005172 if (lex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() &&
5173 rex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Daniel Dunbar523aa602009-01-05 22:55:36 +00005174 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5175 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5176 }
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005177
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005178 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005179
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005180 if (!lex->getType()->isIntegerType() || !rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
5181 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005182
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005183 // Check for remainder by zero.
5184 if (rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Chris Lattnercb329c52010-01-12 21:30:55 +00005185 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_remainder_by_zero)
5186 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005187
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005188 return compType;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005189}
5190
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005191QualType Sema::CheckAdditionOperands( // C99 6.5.6
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005192 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005193 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5194 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5195 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
5196 return compType;
5197 }
Steve Naroff49b45262007-07-13 16:58:59 +00005198
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005199 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005200
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005201 // handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005202 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() &&
5203 rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
5204 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005205 return compType;
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005206 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005207
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005208 // Put any potential pointer into PExp
5209 Expr* PExp = lex, *IExp = rex;
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005210 if (IExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType())
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005211 std::swap(PExp, IExp);
5212
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005213 if (PExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005214
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005215 if (IExp->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
Steve Naroff760e3c42009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005216 QualType PointeeTy = PExp->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005217
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005218 // Check for arithmetic on pointers to incomplete types.
5219 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005220 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5221 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00005222 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor4ec339f2009-01-19 19:26:10 +00005223 return QualType();
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005224 }
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005225
5226 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
5227 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5228 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005229 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005230 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5231 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
5232 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
5233 return QualType();
5234 }
5235
5236 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5237 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
5238 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff9deaeca2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00005239 } else {
Steve Naroff760e3c42009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005240 // Check if we require a complete type.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005241 if (((PExp->getType()->isPointerType() &&
Steve Naroff9deaeca2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00005242 !PExp->getType()->isDependentType()) ||
Steve Naroff760e3c42009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005243 PExp->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) &&
5244 RequireCompleteType(Loc, PointeeTy,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005245 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
5246 << PExp->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005247 << PExp->getType()))
Steve Naroff760e3c42009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005248 return QualType();
5249 }
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005250 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005251 if (PointeeTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005252 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5253 << PointeeTy << PExp->getSourceRange();
5254 return QualType();
5255 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005256
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005257 if (CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005258 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lex);
5259 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
5260 LHSTy = lex->getType();
5261 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
5262 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005263 }
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005264 *CompLHSTy = LHSTy;
5265 }
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005266 return PExp->getType();
5267 }
5268 }
5269
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005270 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005271}
5272
Chris Lattnereca7be62008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005273// C99 6.5.6
5274QualType Sema::CheckSubtractionOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005275 SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
5276 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5277 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5278 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
5279 return compType;
5280 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005281
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005282 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005283
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005284 // Enforce type constraints: C99 6.5.6p3.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005285
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005286 // Handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Mike Stumpaf199f32009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005287 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType()
5288 && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005289 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005290 return compType;
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005291 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005292
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005293 // Either ptr - int or ptr - ptr.
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005294 if (lex->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Steve Naroff430ee5a2009-07-13 17:19:15 +00005295 QualType lpointee = lex->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005296
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005297 // The LHS must be an completely-defined object type.
Douglas Gregorc983b862009-01-23 00:36:41 +00005298
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005299 bool ComplainAboutVoid = false;
5300 Expr *ComplainAboutFunc = 0;
5301 if (lpointee->isVoidType()) {
5302 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5303 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5304 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5305 return QualType();
5306 }
5307
5308 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
5309 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
5310 } else if (lpointee->isFunctionType()) {
5311 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5312 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005313 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005314 return QualType();
5315 }
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005316
5317 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5318 ComplainAboutFunc = lex;
5319 } else if (!lpointee->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005320 RequireCompleteType(Loc, lpointee,
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005321 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005322 << lex->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005323 << lex->getType()))
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005324 return QualType();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005325
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005326 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005327 if (lpointee->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005328 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5329 << lpointee << lex->getSourceRange();
5330 return QualType();
5331 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005332
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005333 // The result type of a pointer-int computation is the pointer type.
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005334 if (rex->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
5335 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
5336 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5337 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5338 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
5339 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005340 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005341 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
5342
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005343 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005344 return lex->getType();
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005345 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005346
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005347 // Handle pointer-pointer subtractions.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005348 if (const PointerType *RHSPTy = rex->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Eli Friedman8e54ad02008-02-08 01:19:44 +00005349 QualType rpointee = RHSPTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005350
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005351 // RHS must be a completely-type object type.
5352 // Handle the GNU void* extension.
5353 if (rpointee->isVoidType()) {
5354 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5355 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5356 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5357 return QualType();
5358 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005359
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005360 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
5361 } else if (rpointee->isFunctionType()) {
5362 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5363 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005364 << rex->getType() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005365 return QualType();
5366 }
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005367
5368 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5369 if (!ComplainAboutFunc)
5370 ComplainAboutFunc = rex;
5371 } else if (!rpointee->isDependentType() &&
5372 RequireCompleteType(Loc, rpointee,
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005373 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
5374 << rex->getSourceRange()
5375 << rex->getType()))
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005376 return QualType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005377
Eli Friedman88d936b2009-05-16 13:54:38 +00005378 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5379 // Pointee types must be the same: C++ [expr.add]
5380 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lpointee, rpointee)) {
5381 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
5382 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
5383 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5384 return QualType();
5385 }
5386 } else {
5387 // Pointee types must be compatible C99 6.5.6p3
5388 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(
5389 Context.getCanonicalType(lpointee).getUnqualifiedType(),
5390 Context.getCanonicalType(rpointee).getUnqualifiedType())) {
5391 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
5392 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
5393 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5394 return QualType();
5395 }
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005396 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005397
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005398 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
5399 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5400 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5401 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
5402 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005403 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005404 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005405
5406 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005407 return Context.getPointerDiffType();
5408 }
5409 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005410
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005411 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005412}
5413
Chris Lattnereca7be62008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005414// C99 6.5.7
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005415QualType Sema::CheckShiftOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Chris Lattnereca7be62008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005416 bool isCompAssign) {
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005417 // C99 6.5.7p2: Each of the operands shall have integer type.
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005418 if (!lex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() ||
5419 !rex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005420 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005421
Nate Begeman2207d792009-10-25 02:26:48 +00005422 // Vector shifts promote their scalar inputs to vector type.
5423 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
5424 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5425
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005426 // Shifts don't perform usual arithmetic conversions, they just do integer
5427 // promotions on each operand. C99 6.5.7p3
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005428 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lex);
5429 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
5430 LHSTy = lex->getType();
5431 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
5432 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005433 }
Chris Lattner1dcf2c82007-12-13 07:28:16 +00005434 if (!isCompAssign)
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005435 ImpCastExprToType(lex, LHSTy, CK_IntegralCast);
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005436
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005437 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005438
Ryan Flynnd0439682009-08-07 16:20:20 +00005439 // Sanity-check shift operands
5440 llvm::APSInt Right;
5441 // Check right/shifter operand
Daniel Dunbar3f180c62009-09-17 06:31:27 +00005442 if (!rex->isValueDependent() &&
5443 rex->isIntegerConstantExpr(Right, Context)) {
Ryan Flynn8045c732009-08-08 19:18:23 +00005444 if (Right.isNegative())
Ryan Flynnd0439682009-08-07 16:20:20 +00005445 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_negative) << rex->getSourceRange();
5446 else {
5447 llvm::APInt LeftBits(Right.getBitWidth(),
5448 Context.getTypeSize(lex->getType()));
5449 if (Right.uge(LeftBits))
5450 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_gt_typewidth) << rex->getSourceRange();
5451 }
5452 }
5453
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005454 // "The type of the result is that of the promoted left operand."
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005455 return LHSTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005456}
5457
Chandler Carruth99919472010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005458static bool IsWithinTemplateSpecialization(Decl *D) {
5459 if (DeclContext *DC = D->getDeclContext()) {
5460 if (isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(DC))
5461 return true;
5462 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(DC))
5463 return FD->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization();
5464 }
5465 return false;
5466}
5467
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005468// C99 6.5.8, C++ [expr.rel]
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005469QualType Sema::CheckCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005470 unsigned OpaqueOpc, bool isRelational) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005471 BinaryOperatorKind Opc = (BinaryOperatorKind) OpaqueOpc;
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005472
Chris Lattner02dd4b12009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005473 // Handle vector comparisons separately.
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005474 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005475 return CheckVectorCompareOperands(lex, rex, Loc, isRelational);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005476
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00005477 QualType lType = lex->getType();
5478 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005479
Douglas Gregor8eee1192010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005480 if (!lType->hasFloatingRepresentation() &&
Ted Kremenekfbcb0eb2010-09-16 00:03:01 +00005481 !(lType->isBlockPointerType() && isRelational) &&
5482 !lex->getLocStart().isMacroID() &&
5483 !rex->getLocStart().isMacroID()) {
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005484 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
5485 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
5486 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
Chandler Carruth64d092c2010-07-12 06:23:38 +00005487 //
5488 // NOTE: Don't warn about comparison expressions resulting from macro
5489 // expansion. Also don't warn about comparisons which are only self
5490 // comparisons within a template specialization. The warnings should catch
5491 // obvious cases in the definition of the template anyways. The idea is to
5492 // warn when the typed comparison operator will always evaluate to the same
5493 // result.
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005494 Expr *LHSStripped = lex->IgnoreParens();
5495 Expr *RHSStripped = rex->IgnoreParens();
Chandler Carruth99919472010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005496 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(LHSStripped)) {
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005497 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(RHSStripped)) {
Ted Kremenekfbcb0eb2010-09-16 00:03:01 +00005498 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl() &&
Chandler Carruth99919472010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005499 !IsWithinTemplateSpecialization(DRL->getDecl())) {
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005500 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5501 << 0 // self-
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005502 << (Opc == BO_EQ
5503 || Opc == BO_LE
5504 || Opc == BO_GE));
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005505 } else if (lType->isArrayType() && rType->isArrayType() &&
5506 !DRL->getDecl()->getType()->isReferenceType() &&
5507 !DRR->getDecl()->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
5508 // what is it always going to eval to?
5509 char always_evals_to;
5510 switch(Opc) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005511 case BO_EQ: // e.g. array1 == array2
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005512 always_evals_to = 0; // false
5513 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005514 case BO_NE: // e.g. array1 != array2
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005515 always_evals_to = 1; // true
5516 break;
5517 default:
5518 // best we can say is 'a constant'
5519 always_evals_to = 2; // e.g. array1 <= array2
5520 break;
5521 }
5522 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5523 << 1 // array
5524 << always_evals_to);
5525 }
5526 }
Chandler Carruth99919472010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005527 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005528
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005529 if (isa<CastExpr>(LHSStripped))
5530 LHSStripped = LHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
5531 if (isa<CastExpr>(RHSStripped))
5532 RHSStripped = RHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005533
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005534 // Warn about comparisons against a string constant (unless the other
5535 // operand is null), the user probably wants strcmp.
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005536 Expr *literalString = 0;
5537 Expr *literalStringStripped = 0;
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005538 if ((isa<StringLiteral>(LHSStripped) || isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(LHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005539 !RHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005540 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005541 literalString = lex;
5542 literalStringStripped = LHSStripped;
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00005543 } else if ((isa<StringLiteral>(RHSStripped) ||
5544 isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(RHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005545 !LHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005546 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005547 literalString = rex;
5548 literalStringStripped = RHSStripped;
5549 }
5550
5551 if (literalString) {
5552 std::string resultComparison;
5553 switch (Opc) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005554 case BO_LT: resultComparison = ") < 0"; break;
5555 case BO_GT: resultComparison = ") > 0"; break;
5556 case BO_LE: resultComparison = ") <= 0"; break;
5557 case BO_GE: resultComparison = ") >= 0"; break;
5558 case BO_EQ: resultComparison = ") == 0"; break;
5559 case BO_NE: resultComparison = ") != 0"; break;
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005560 default: assert(false && "Invalid comparison operator");
5561 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005562
Douglas Gregord1e4d9b2010-01-12 23:18:54 +00005563 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc,
5564 PDiag(diag::warn_stringcompare)
5565 << isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(literalStringStripped)
Ted Kremenek03a4bee2010-04-09 20:26:53 +00005566 << literalString->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005567 }
Ted Kremenek3ca0bf22007-10-29 16:58:49 +00005568 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005569
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005570 // C99 6.5.8p3 / C99 6.5.9p4
5571 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
5572 UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex);
5573 else {
5574 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
5575 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
5576 }
5577
5578 lType = lex->getType();
5579 rType = rex->getType();
5580
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005581 // The result of comparisons is 'bool' in C++, 'int' in C.
Chris Lattner02dd4b12009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005582 QualType ResultTy = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy:Context.IntTy;
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005583
Chris Lattnera5937dd2007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005584 if (isRelational) {
5585 if (lType->isRealType() && rType->isRealType())
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005586 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnera5937dd2007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005587 } else {
Ted Kremenek72cb1ae2007-10-29 17:13:39 +00005588 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
Douglas Gregor8eee1192010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005589 if (lType->hasFloatingRepresentation())
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005590 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005591
Chris Lattnera5937dd2007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005592 if (lType->isArithmeticType() && rType->isArithmeticType())
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005593 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnera5937dd2007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005594 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005595
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005596 bool LHSIsNull = lex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005597 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005598 bool RHSIsNull = rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005599 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005600
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005601 // All of the following pointer-related warnings are GCC extensions, except
5602 // when handling null pointer constants.
Steve Naroff77878cc2007-08-27 04:08:11 +00005603 if (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isPointerType()) { // C99 6.5.8p2
Chris Lattnerbc896f52008-04-03 05:07:25 +00005604 QualType LCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005605 Context.getCanonicalType(lType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Chris Lattnerbc896f52008-04-03 05:07:25 +00005606 QualType RCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005607 Context.getCanonicalType(rType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005608
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005609 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Eli Friedman3075e762009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005610 if (LCanPointeeTy == RCanPointeeTy)
5611 return ResultTy;
Fariborz Jahanian51874dd2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005612 if (!isRelational &&
5613 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
5614 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
5615 // This is a gcc extension compatibility comparison.
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005616 // In a SFINAE context, we treat this as a hard error to maintain
5617 // conformance with the C++ standard.
Fariborz Jahanian51874dd2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005618 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
5619 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005620 Diag(Loc,
5621 isSFINAEContext()?
5622 diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void
5623 : diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
Fariborz Jahanian51874dd2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005624 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005625
5626 if (isSFINAEContext())
5627 return QualType();
5628
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005629 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanian51874dd2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005630 return ResultTy;
5631 }
5632 }
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005633 // C++ [expr.rel]p2:
5634 // [...] Pointer conversions (4.10) and qualification
5635 // conversions (4.4) are performed on pointer operands (or on
5636 // a pointer operand and a null pointer constant) to bring
5637 // them to their composite pointer type. [...]
5638 //
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005639 // C++ [expr.eq]p1 uses the same notion for (in)equality
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005640 // comparisons of pointers.
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005641 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
Douglas Gregor8f00dcf2010-04-16 23:20:25 +00005642 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(Loc, lex, rex,
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005643 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005644 if (T.isNull()) {
5645 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
5646 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5647 return QualType();
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005648 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005649 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005650 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005651 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005652 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005653 }
5654
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005655 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CK_BitCast);
5656 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005657 return ResultTy;
5658 }
Eli Friedman3075e762009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005659 // C99 6.5.9p2 and C99 6.5.8p2
5660 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(LCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType(),
5661 RCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType())) {
5662 // Valid unless a relational comparison of function pointers
5663 if (isRelational && LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
5664 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_function_pointers)
5665 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5666 }
5667 } else if (!isRelational &&
5668 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
5669 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
5670 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
5671 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
5672 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
5673 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5674 }
5675 } else {
5676 // Invalid
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005677 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005678 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005679 }
Eli Friedman3075e762009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005680 if (LCanPointeeTy != RCanPointeeTy)
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005681 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005682 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffe77fd3c2007-08-16 21:48:38 +00005683 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005684
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005685 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005686 // Comparison of pointers with null pointer constants and equality
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005687 // comparisons of member pointers to null pointer constants.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005688 if (RHSIsNull &&
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005689 (lType->isPointerType() ||
5690 (!isRelational && lType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Douglas Gregor443c2122010-08-07 13:36:37 +00005691 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType,
5692 lType->isMemberPointerType()
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005693 ? CK_NullToMemberPointer
5694 : CK_IntegralToPointer);
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005695 return ResultTy;
5696 }
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005697 if (LHSIsNull &&
5698 (rType->isPointerType() ||
5699 (!isRelational && rType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Douglas Gregor443c2122010-08-07 13:36:37 +00005700 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType,
5701 rType->isMemberPointerType()
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005702 ? CK_NullToMemberPointer
5703 : CK_IntegralToPointer);
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005704 return ResultTy;
5705 }
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005706
5707 // Comparison of member pointers.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005708 if (!isRelational &&
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005709 lType->isMemberPointerType() && rType->isMemberPointerType()) {
5710 // C++ [expr.eq]p2:
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005711 // In addition, pointers to members can be compared, or a pointer to
5712 // member and a null pointer constant. Pointer to member conversions
5713 // (4.11) and qualification conversions (4.4) are performed to bring
5714 // them to a common type. If one operand is a null pointer constant,
5715 // the common type is the type of the other operand. Otherwise, the
5716 // common type is a pointer to member type similar (4.4) to the type
5717 // of one of the operands, with a cv-qualification signature (4.4)
5718 // that is the union of the cv-qualification signatures of the operand
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005719 // types.
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005720 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
Douglas Gregor8f00dcf2010-04-16 23:20:25 +00005721 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(Loc, lex, rex,
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005722 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005723 if (T.isNull()) {
5724 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005725 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005726 return QualType();
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005727 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005728 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005729 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005730 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005731 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005732 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005733
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005734 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CK_BitCast);
5735 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005736 return ResultTy;
5737 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005738
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005739 // Comparison of nullptr_t with itself.
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005740 if (lType->isNullPtrType() && rType->isNullPtrType())
5741 return ResultTy;
5742 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005743
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005744 // Handle block pointer types.
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005745 if (!isRelational && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005746 QualType lpointee = lType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5747 QualType rpointee = rType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005748
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005749 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull &&
Eli Friedman26784c12009-06-08 05:08:54 +00005750 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lpointee, rpointee)) {
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005751 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005752 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005753 }
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005754 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005755 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005756 }
Steve Naroff59f53942008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005757 // Allow block pointers to be compared with null pointer constants.
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005758 if (!isRelational
5759 && ((lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isPointerType())
5760 || (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()))) {
Steve Naroff59f53942008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005761 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005762 if (!((rType->isPointerType() && rType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005763 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005764 || (lType->isPointerType() && lType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005765 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())))
5766 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
5767 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff59f53942008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005768 }
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005769 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005770 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff59f53942008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005771 }
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005772
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005773 if ((lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() || rType->isObjCObjectPointerType())) {
Steve Naroffa5ad8632008-10-27 10:33:19 +00005774 if (lType->isPointerType() || rType->isPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005775 const PointerType *LPT = lType->getAs<PointerType>();
5776 const PointerType *RPT = rType->getAs<PointerType>();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005777 bool LPtrToVoid = LPT ?
Steve Naroffa8069f12008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005778 Context.getCanonicalType(LPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005779 bool RPtrToVoid = RPT ?
Steve Naroffa8069f12008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005780 Context.getCanonicalType(RPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005781
Steve Naroffa8069f12008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005782 if (!LPtrToVoid && !RPtrToVoid &&
5783 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lType, rType)) {
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005784 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005785 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffa5ad8632008-10-27 10:33:19 +00005786 }
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005787 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005788 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff87f3b932008-10-20 18:19:10 +00005789 }
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005790 if (lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && rType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Chris Lattner6365e3e2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005791 if (!Context.areComparableObjCPointerTypes(lType, rType))
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005792 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
5793 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005794 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005795 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff20373222008-06-03 14:04:54 +00005796 }
Fariborz Jahanian7359f042007-12-20 01:06:58 +00005797 }
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005798 if ((lType->isAnyPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) ||
5799 (lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isAnyPointerType())) {
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005800 unsigned DiagID = 0;
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005801 bool isError = false;
5802 if ((LHSIsNull && lType->isIntegerType()) ||
5803 (RHSIsNull && rType->isIntegerType())) {
5804 if (isRelational && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005805 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_and_zero;
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005806 } else if (isRelational && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005807 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005808 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5809 DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
5810 isError = true;
5811 } else
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005812 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005813
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005814 if (DiagID) {
Chris Lattner6365e3e2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005815 Diag(Loc, DiagID)
Chris Lattner149f1382009-06-30 06:24:05 +00005816 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005817 if (isError)
5818 return QualType();
Chris Lattner6365e3e2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005819 }
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005820
5821 if (lType->isIntegerType())
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005822 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005823 else
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005824 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005825 return ResultTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005826 }
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005827
Steve Naroff39218df2008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005828 // Handle block pointers.
Mike Stumpaf199f32009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005829 if (!isRelational && RHSIsNull
5830 && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005831 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005832 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff39218df2008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005833 }
Mike Stumpaf199f32009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005834 if (!isRelational && LHSIsNull
5835 && lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005836 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005837 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff39218df2008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005838 }
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005839 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005840}
5841
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005842/// CheckVectorCompareOperands - vector comparisons are a clang extension that
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005843/// operates on extended vector types. Instead of producing an IntTy result,
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005844/// like a scalar comparison, a vector comparison produces a vector of integer
5845/// types.
5846QualType Sema::CheckVectorCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005847 SourceLocation Loc,
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005848 bool isRelational) {
5849 // Check to make sure we're operating on vectors of the same type and width,
5850 // Allowing one side to be a scalar of element type.
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005851 QualType vType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005852 if (vType.isNull())
5853 return vType;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005854
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005855 QualType lType = lex->getType();
5856 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005857
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005858 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
5859 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
5860 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
Douglas Gregor8eee1192010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005861 if (!lType->hasFloatingRepresentation()) {
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005862 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(lex->IgnoreParens()))
5863 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(rex->IgnoreParens()))
5864 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl())
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005865 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc,
5866 PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5867 << 0 // self-
5868 << 2 // "a constant"
5869 );
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005870 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005871
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005872 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
Douglas Gregor8eee1192010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005873 if (!isRelational && lType->hasFloatingRepresentation()) {
5874 assert (rType->hasFloatingRepresentation());
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005875 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005876 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005877
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005878 // Return the type for the comparison, which is the same as vector type for
5879 // integer vectors, or an integer type of identical size and number of
5880 // elements for floating point vectors.
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005881 if (lType->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005882 return lType;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005883
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005884 const VectorType *VTy = lType->getAs<VectorType>();
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005885 unsigned TypeSize = Context.getTypeSize(VTy->getElementType());
Nate Begeman59b5da62009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005886 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy))
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005887 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.IntTy, VTy->getNumElements());
Chris Lattnerd013aa12009-03-31 07:46:52 +00005888 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongTy))
Nate Begeman59b5da62009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005889 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
5890
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005891 assert(TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongLongTy) &&
Nate Begeman59b5da62009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005892 "Unhandled vector element size in vector compare");
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005893 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongLongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
5894}
5895
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005896inline QualType Sema::CheckBitwiseOperands(
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005897 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005898 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5899 if (lex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() &&
5900 rex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
5901 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5902
5903 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5904 }
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005905
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005906 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005907
Steve Naroffa4332e22007-07-17 00:58:39 +00005908 if (lex->getType()->isIntegerType() && rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005909 return compType;
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005910 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005911}
5912
5913inline QualType Sema::CheckLogicalOperands( // C99 6.5.[13,14]
Chris Lattner90a8f272010-07-13 19:41:32 +00005914 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, unsigned Opc) {
5915
5916 // Diagnose cases where the user write a logical and/or but probably meant a
5917 // bitwise one. We do this when the LHS is a non-bool integer and the RHS
5918 // is a constant.
5919 if (lex->getType()->isIntegerType() && !lex->getType()->isBooleanType() &&
Eli Friedman787b0942010-07-27 19:14:53 +00005920 rex->getType()->isIntegerType() && !rex->isValueDependent() &&
Chris Lattner23ef3e42010-07-15 00:26:43 +00005921 // Don't warn in macros.
Chris Lattnerb7690b42010-07-24 01:10:11 +00005922 !Loc.isMacroID()) {
5923 // If the RHS can be constant folded, and if it constant folds to something
5924 // that isn't 0 or 1 (which indicate a potential logical operation that
5925 // happened to fold to true/false) then warn.
5926 Expr::EvalResult Result;
5927 if (rex->Evaluate(Result, Context) && !Result.HasSideEffects &&
5928 Result.Val.getInt() != 0 && Result.Val.getInt() != 1) {
5929 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_logical_instead_of_bitwise)
5930 << rex->getSourceRange()
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005931 << (Opc == BO_LAnd ? "&&" : "||")
5932 << (Opc == BO_LAnd ? "&" : "|");
Chris Lattnerb7690b42010-07-24 01:10:11 +00005933 }
5934 }
Chris Lattner90a8f272010-07-13 19:41:32 +00005935
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005936 if (!Context.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5937 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
5938 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005939
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005940 if (!lex->getType()->isScalarType() || !rex->getType()->isScalarType())
5941 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005942
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005943 return Context.IntTy;
Anders Carlsson04905012009-10-16 01:44:21 +00005944 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005945
John McCall75f7c0f2010-06-04 00:29:51 +00005946 // The following is safe because we only use this method for
5947 // non-overloadable operands.
5948
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005949 // C++ [expr.log.and]p1
5950 // C++ [expr.log.or]p1
John McCall75f7c0f2010-06-04 00:29:51 +00005951 // The operands are both contextually converted to type bool.
5952 if (PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(lex) ||
5953 PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(rex))
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005954 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005955
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005956 // C++ [expr.log.and]p2
5957 // C++ [expr.log.or]p2
5958 // The result is a bool.
5959 return Context.BoolTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005960}
5961
Fariborz Jahaniand1fa6442009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005962/// IsReadonlyProperty - Verify that otherwise a valid l-value expression
5963/// is a read-only property; return true if so. A readonly property expression
5964/// depends on various declarations and thus must be treated specially.
5965///
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005966static bool IsReadonlyProperty(Expr *E, Sema &S) {
Fariborz Jahaniand1fa6442009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005967 if (E->getStmtClass() == Expr::ObjCPropertyRefExprClass) {
5968 const ObjCPropertyRefExpr* PropExpr = cast<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(E);
5969 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PDecl = PropExpr->getProperty()) {
5970 QualType BaseType = PropExpr->getBase()->getType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005971 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005972 BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())
5973 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = OPT->getInterfaceDecl())
5974 if (S.isPropertyReadonly(PDecl, IFace))
5975 return true;
Fariborz Jahaniand1fa6442009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005976 }
5977 }
5978 return false;
5979}
5980
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005981/// CheckForModifiableLvalue - Verify that E is a modifiable lvalue. If not,
5982/// emit an error and return true. If so, return false.
5983static bool CheckForModifiableLvalue(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc, Sema &S) {
Daniel Dunbar44e35f72009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005984 SourceLocation OrigLoc = Loc;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005985 Expr::isModifiableLvalueResult IsLV = E->isModifiableLvalue(S.Context,
Daniel Dunbar44e35f72009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005986 &Loc);
Fariborz Jahaniand1fa6442009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005987 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid && IsReadonlyProperty(E, S))
5988 IsLV = Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty;
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005989 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid)
5990 return false;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005991
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005992 unsigned Diag = 0;
5993 bool NeedType = false;
5994 switch (IsLV) { // C99 6.5.16p2
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005995 case Expr::MLV_ConstQualified: Diag = diag::err_typecheck_assign_const; break;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005996 case Expr::MLV_ArrayType:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005997 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_array_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5998 NeedType = true;
5999 break;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006000 case Expr::MLV_NotObjectType:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006001 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_non_object_not_modifiable_lvalue;
6002 NeedType = true;
6003 break;
Chris Lattnerca354fa2008-11-17 19:51:54 +00006004 case Expr::MLV_LValueCast:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006005 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_lvalue_casts_not_supported;
6006 break;
Douglas Gregore873fb72010-02-16 21:39:57 +00006007 case Expr::MLV_Valid:
6008 llvm_unreachable("did not take early return for MLV_Valid");
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006009 case Expr::MLV_InvalidExpression:
Douglas Gregore873fb72010-02-16 21:39:57 +00006010 case Expr::MLV_MemberFunction:
6011 case Expr::MLV_ClassTemporary:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006012 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_expression_not_modifiable_lvalue;
6013 break;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006014 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteType:
6015 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteVoidType:
Douglas Gregor86447ec2009-03-09 16:13:40 +00006016 return S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, E->getType(),
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006017 S.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_type_not_modifiable_lvalue)
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00006018 << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006019 case Expr::MLV_DuplicateVectorComponents:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006020 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_duplicate_vector_components_not_mlvalue;
6021 break;
Steve Naroff4f6a7d72008-09-26 14:41:28 +00006022 case Expr::MLV_NotBlockQualified:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006023 Diag = diag::err_block_decl_ref_not_modifiable_lvalue;
6024 break;
Fariborz Jahanian5daf5702008-11-22 18:39:36 +00006025 case Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty:
6026 Diag = diag::error_readonly_property_assignment;
6027 break;
Fariborz Jahanianba8d2d62008-11-22 20:25:50 +00006028 case Expr::MLV_NoSetterProperty:
6029 Diag = diag::error_nosetter_property_assignment;
6030 break;
Fariborz Jahanian2514a302009-12-15 23:59:41 +00006031 case Expr::MLV_SubObjCPropertySetting:
6032 Diag = diag::error_no_subobject_property_setting;
6033 break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006034 }
Steve Naroffd1861fd2007-07-31 12:34:36 +00006035
Daniel Dunbar44e35f72009-04-15 00:08:05 +00006036 SourceRange Assign;
6037 if (Loc != OrigLoc)
6038 Assign = SourceRange(OrigLoc, OrigLoc);
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006039 if (NeedType)
Daniel Dunbar44e35f72009-04-15 00:08:05 +00006040 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getType() << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006041 else
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006042 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006043 return true;
6044}
6045
6046
6047
6048// C99 6.5.16.1
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006049QualType Sema::CheckAssignmentOperands(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS,
6050 SourceLocation Loc,
6051 QualType CompoundType) {
6052 // Verify that LHS is a modifiable lvalue, and emit error if not.
6053 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(LHS, Loc, *this))
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006054 return QualType();
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006055
6056 QualType LHSType = LHS->getType();
6057 QualType RHSType = CompoundType.isNull() ? RHS->getType() : CompoundType;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006058 AssignConvertType ConvTy;
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006059 if (CompoundType.isNull()) {
Fariborz Jahaniane2a901a2010-06-07 22:02:01 +00006060 QualType LHSTy(LHSType);
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006061 // Simple assignment "x = y".
Fariborz Jahanianc4e1a682010-09-14 23:02:38 +00006062 ConvertPropertyAssignment(LHS, RHS, LHSTy);
Fariborz Jahaniane2a901a2010-06-07 22:02:01 +00006063 ConvTy = CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(LHSTy, RHS);
Fariborz Jahanianfa23c1d2009-01-13 23:34:40 +00006064 // Special case of NSObject attributes on c-style pointer types.
6065 if (ConvTy == IncompatiblePointer &&
6066 ((Context.isObjCNSObjectType(LHSType) &&
Steve Narofff4954562009-07-16 15:41:00 +00006067 RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
Fariborz Jahanianfa23c1d2009-01-13 23:34:40 +00006068 (Context.isObjCNSObjectType(RHSType) &&
Steve Narofff4954562009-07-16 15:41:00 +00006069 LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType())))
Fariborz Jahanianfa23c1d2009-01-13 23:34:40 +00006070 ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006071
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006072 // If the RHS is a unary plus or minus, check to see if they = and + are
6073 // right next to each other. If so, the user may have typo'd "x =+ 4"
6074 // instead of "x += 4".
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006075 Expr *RHSCheck = RHS;
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006076 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(RHSCheck))
6077 RHSCheck = ICE->getSubExpr();
6078 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(RHSCheck)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006079 if ((UO->getOpcode() == UO_Plus ||
6080 UO->getOpcode() == UO_Minus) &&
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006081 Loc.isFileID() && UO->getOperatorLoc().isFileID() &&
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006082 // Only if the two operators are exactly adjacent.
Chris Lattner399bd1b2009-03-08 06:51:10 +00006083 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(1) == UO->getOperatorLoc() &&
6084 // And there is a space or other character before the subexpr of the
6085 // unary +/-. We don't want to warn on "x=-1".
Chris Lattner3e872092009-03-09 07:11:10 +00006086 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(2) != UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart() &&
6087 UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart().isFileID()) {
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006088 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_compound_assign)
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006089 << (UO->getOpcode() == UO_Plus ? "+" : "-")
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006090 << SourceRange(UO->getOperatorLoc(), UO->getOperatorLoc());
Chris Lattner399bd1b2009-03-08 06:51:10 +00006091 }
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006092 }
6093 } else {
6094 // Compound assignment "x += y"
Eli Friedman623712b2009-05-16 05:56:02 +00006095 ConvTy = CheckAssignmentConstraints(LHSType, RHSType);
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006096 }
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006097
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006098 if (DiagnoseAssignmentResult(ConvTy, Loc, LHSType, RHSType,
Douglas Gregor68647482009-12-16 03:45:30 +00006099 RHS, AA_Assigning))
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006100 return QualType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006101
Chris Lattner8b5dec32010-07-07 06:14:23 +00006102
6103 // Check to see if the destination operand is a dereferenced null pointer. If
6104 // so, and if not volatile-qualified, this is undefined behavior that the
6105 // optimizer will delete, so warn about it. People sometimes try to use this
6106 // to get a deterministic trap and are surprised by clang's behavior. This
6107 // only handles the pattern "*null = whatever", which is a very syntactic
6108 // check.
6109 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(LHS->IgnoreParenCasts()))
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006110 if (UO->getOpcode() == UO_Deref &&
Chris Lattner8b5dec32010-07-07 06:14:23 +00006111 UO->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParenCasts()->
6112 isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull) &&
6113 !UO->getType().isVolatileQualified()) {
6114 Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::warn_indirection_through_null)
6115 << UO->getSubExpr()->getSourceRange();
6116 Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::note_indirection_through_null);
6117 }
6118
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006119 // C99 6.5.16p3: The type of an assignment expression is the type of the
6120 // left operand unless the left operand has qualified type, in which case
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006121 // it is the unqualified version of the type of the left operand.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006122 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: In simple assignment, the value of the right operand
6123 // is converted to the type of the assignment expression (above).
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006124 // C++ 5.17p1: the type of the assignment expression is that of its left
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +00006125 // operand.
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006126 return LHSType.getUnqualifiedType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006127}
6128
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006129// C99 6.5.17
6130QualType Sema::CheckCommaOperands(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS, SourceLocation Loc) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis25973452010-06-30 10:53:14 +00006131 DiagnoseUnusedExprResult(LHS);
6132
Chris Lattner53fcaa92008-07-25 20:54:07 +00006133 // Comma performs lvalue conversion (C99 6.3.2.1), but not unary conversions.
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006134 // C++ does not perform this conversion (C++ [expr.comma]p1).
6135 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
6136 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS);
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00006137
6138 // FIXME: Check that RHS type is complete in C mode (it's legal for it to be
6139 // incomplete in C++).
6140
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006141 return RHS->getType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006142}
6143
Steve Naroff49b45262007-07-13 16:58:59 +00006144/// CheckIncrementDecrementOperand - unlike most "Check" methods, this routine
6145/// doesn't need to call UsualUnaryConversions or UsualArithmeticConversions.
Sebastian Redle6d5a4a2008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006146QualType Sema::CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Expr *Op, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00006147 bool isInc, bool isPrefix) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006148 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
6149 return Context.DependentTy;
6150
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006151 QualType ResType = Op->getType();
6152 assert(!ResType.isNull() && "no type for increment/decrement expression");
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006153
Sebastian Redle6d5a4a2008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006154 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && ResType->isBooleanType()) {
6155 // Decrement of bool is not allowed.
6156 if (!isInc) {
6157 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_decrement_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
6158 return QualType();
6159 }
6160 // Increment of bool sets it to true, but is deprecated.
6161 Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_increment_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
6162 } else if (ResType->isRealType()) {
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006163 // OK!
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00006164 } else if (ResType->isAnyPointerType()) {
6165 QualType PointeeTy = ResType->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006166
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006167 // C99 6.5.2.4p2, 6.5.6p2
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006168 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregorc983b862009-01-23 00:36:41 +00006169 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6170 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
6171 << Op->getSourceRange();
6172 return QualType();
6173 }
6174
6175 // Pointer to void is a GNU extension in C.
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006176 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr) << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006177 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Douglas Gregorc983b862009-01-23 00:36:41 +00006178 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6179 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
6180 << Op->getType() << Op->getSourceRange();
6181 return QualType();
6182 }
6183
6184 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006185 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006186 } else if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, PointeeTy,
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00006187 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006188 << Op->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00006189 << ResType))
Douglas Gregor4ec339f2009-01-19 19:26:10 +00006190 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanian9f8a04f2009-07-16 17:59:14 +00006191 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006192 else if (PointeeTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Fariborz Jahanian9f8a04f2009-07-16 17:59:14 +00006193 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
6194 << PointeeTy << Op->getSourceRange();
6195 return QualType();
6196 }
Eli Friedman5b088a12010-01-03 00:20:48 +00006197 } else if (ResType->isAnyComplexType()) {
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006198 // C99 does not support ++/-- on complex types, we allow as an extension.
6199 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_increment_complex)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006200 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006201 } else {
6202 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_illegal_increment_decrement)
Douglas Gregor5cc07df2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00006203 << ResType << int(isInc) << Op->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006204 return QualType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006205 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006206 // At this point, we know we have a real, complex or pointer type.
Steve Naroffdd10e022007-08-23 21:37:33 +00006207 // Now make sure the operand is a modifiable lvalue.
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006208 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(Op, OpLoc, *this))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006209 return QualType();
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00006210 // In C++, a prefix increment is the same type as the operand. Otherwise
6211 // (in C or with postfix), the increment is the unqualified type of the
6212 // operand.
6213 return isPrefix && getLangOptions().CPlusPlus
6214 ? ResType : ResType.getUnqualifiedType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006215}
6216
Fariborz Jahanianc4e1a682010-09-14 23:02:38 +00006217void Sema::ConvertPropertyAssignment(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS, QualType& LHSTy) {
6218 bool copyInit = false;
6219 if (const ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr *OISGE =
6220 dyn_cast<ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr>(LHS)) {
6221 // If using property-dot syntax notation for assignment, and there is a
6222 // setter, RHS expression is being passed to the setter argument. So,
6223 // type conversion (and comparison) is RHS to setter's argument type.
6224 if (const ObjCMethodDecl *SetterMD = OISGE->getSetterMethod()) {
6225 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P = SetterMD->param_begin();
6226 LHSTy = (*P)->getType();
6227 }
6228 copyInit = (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && LHSTy->isRecordType());
6229 }
6230 else
6231 copyInit = (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && isa<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(LHS) &&
6232 LHSTy->isRecordType());
6233 if (copyInit) {
6234 InitializedEntity Entity =
6235 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(LHSTy);
6236 Expr *Arg = RHS;
6237 ExprResult ArgE = PerformCopyInitialization(Entity, SourceLocation(),
6238 Owned(Arg));
6239 if (!ArgE.isInvalid())
6240 RHS = ArgE.takeAs<Expr>();
6241 }
6242}
6243
6244
Anders Carlsson369dee42008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006245/// getPrimaryDecl - Helper function for CheckAddressOfOperand().
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006246/// This routine allows us to typecheck complex/recursive expressions
Daniel Dunbar1e76ce62008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006247/// where the declaration is needed for type checking. We only need to
6248/// handle cases when the expression references a function designator
6249/// or is an lvalue. Here are some examples:
6250/// - &(x) => x
6251/// - &*****f => f for f a function designator.
6252/// - &s.xx => s
6253/// - &s.zz[1].yy -> s, if zz is an array
6254/// - *(x + 1) -> x, if x is an array
6255/// - &"123"[2] -> 0
6256/// - & __real__ x -> x
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006257static NamedDecl *getPrimaryDecl(Expr *E) {
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006258 switch (E->getStmtClass()) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006259 case Stmt::DeclRefExprClass:
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006260 return cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)->getDecl();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006261 case Stmt::MemberExprClass:
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006262 // If this is an arrow operator, the address is an offset from
6263 // the base's value, so the object the base refers to is
6264 // irrelevant.
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006265 if (cast<MemberExpr>(E)->isArrow())
Chris Lattnerf82228f2007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006266 return 0;
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006267 // Otherwise, the expression refers to a part of the base
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006268 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<MemberExpr>(E)->getBase());
Anders Carlsson369dee42008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006269 case Stmt::ArraySubscriptExprClass: {
Mike Stump390b4cc2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00006270 // FIXME: This code shouldn't be necessary! We should catch the implicit
6271 // promotion of register arrays earlier.
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006272 Expr* Base = cast<ArraySubscriptExpr>(E)->getBase();
6273 if (ImplicitCastExpr* ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Base)) {
6274 if (ICE->getSubExpr()->getType()->isArrayType())
6275 return getPrimaryDecl(ICE->getSubExpr());
6276 }
6277 return 0;
Anders Carlsson369dee42008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006278 }
Daniel Dunbar1e76ce62008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006279 case Stmt::UnaryOperatorClass: {
6280 UnaryOperator *UO = cast<UnaryOperator>(E);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006281
Daniel Dunbar1e76ce62008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006282 switch(UO->getOpcode()) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006283 case UO_Real:
6284 case UO_Imag:
6285 case UO_Extension:
Daniel Dunbar1e76ce62008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006286 return getPrimaryDecl(UO->getSubExpr());
6287 default:
6288 return 0;
6289 }
6290 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006291 case Stmt::ParenExprClass:
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006292 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ParenExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Chris Lattnerf82228f2007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006293 case Stmt::ImplicitCastExprClass:
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006294 // If the result of an implicit cast is an l-value, we care about
6295 // the sub-expression; otherwise, the result here doesn't matter.
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006296 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006297 default:
6298 return 0;
6299 }
6300}
6301
6302/// CheckAddressOfOperand - The operand of & must be either a function
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006303/// designator or an lvalue designating an object. If it is an lvalue, the
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006304/// object cannot be declared with storage class register or be a bit field.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006305/// Note: The usual conversions are *not* applied to the operand of the &
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006306/// operator (C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4]), and its result is never an lvalue.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006307/// In C++, the operand might be an overloaded function name, in which case
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006308/// we allow the '&' but retain the overloaded-function type.
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006309QualType Sema::CheckAddressOfOperand(Expr *OrigOp, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
6310 if (OrigOp->isTypeDependent())
Douglas Gregor9103bb22008-12-17 22:52:20 +00006311 return Context.DependentTy;
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006312 if (OrigOp->getType() == Context.OverloadTy)
6313 return Context.OverloadTy;
6314
6315 // Make sure to ignore parentheses in subsequent checks
6316 Expr *op = OrigOp->IgnoreParens();
Douglas Gregor9103bb22008-12-17 22:52:20 +00006317
Steve Naroff08f19672008-01-13 17:10:08 +00006318 if (getLangOptions().C99) {
6319 // Implement C99-only parts of addressof rules.
6320 if (UnaryOperator* uOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(op)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006321 if (uOp->getOpcode() == UO_Deref)
Steve Naroff08f19672008-01-13 17:10:08 +00006322 // Per C99 6.5.3.2, the address of a deref always returns a valid result
6323 // (assuming the deref expression is valid).
6324 return uOp->getSubExpr()->getType();
6325 }
6326 // Technically, there should be a check for array subscript
6327 // expressions here, but the result of one is always an lvalue anyway.
6328 }
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006329 NamedDecl *dcl = getPrimaryDecl(op);
Chris Lattner28be73f2008-07-26 21:30:36 +00006330 Expr::isLvalueResult lval = op->isLvalue(Context);
Nuno Lopes6b6609f2008-12-16 22:59:47 +00006331
Chris Lattnerfd79a9d2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006332 if (lval == Expr::LV_ClassTemporary) {
Douglas Gregore873fb72010-02-16 21:39:57 +00006333 Diag(OpLoc, isSFINAEContext()? diag::err_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary
6334 : diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary)
6335 << op->getType() << op->getSourceRange();
6336 if (isSFINAEContext())
6337 return QualType();
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006338 } else if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(op)) {
Chris Lattnerfd79a9d2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006339 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006340 } else if (lval == Expr::LV_MemberFunction) {
6341 // If it's an instance method, make a member pointer.
6342 // The expression must have exactly the form &A::foo.
6343
6344 // If the underlying expression isn't a decl ref, give up.
6345 if (!isa<DeclRefExpr>(op)) {
6346 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_invalid_form_pointer_member_function)
6347 << OrigOp->getSourceRange();
6348 return QualType();
6349 }
6350 DeclRefExpr *DRE = cast<DeclRefExpr>(op);
6351 CXXMethodDecl *MD = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DRE->getDecl());
6352
6353 // The id-expression was parenthesized.
6354 if (OrigOp != DRE) {
6355 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_parens_pointer_member_function)
6356 << OrigOp->getSourceRange();
6357
6358 // The method was named without a qualifier.
6359 } else if (!DRE->getQualifier()) {
6360 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_unqualified_pointer_member_function)
6361 << op->getSourceRange();
6362 }
6363
6364 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6365 Context.getTypeDeclType(MD->getParent()).getTypePtr());
6366 } else if (lval != Expr::LV_Valid && lval != Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
Eli Friedman441cf102009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006367 // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006368 // The operand must be either an l-value or a function designator
Eli Friedman441cf102009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006369 if (!op->getType()->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattnerf82228f2007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006370 // FIXME: emit more specific diag...
Chris Lattnerdcd5ef12008-11-19 05:27:50 +00006371 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_lvalue_addrof)
6372 << op->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006373 return QualType();
6374 }
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00006375 } else if (op->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006376 // The operand cannot be a bit-field
6377 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6378 << "bit-field" << op->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor86f19402008-12-20 23:49:58 +00006379 return QualType();
Anders Carlsson09380262010-01-31 17:18:49 +00006380 } else if (op->refersToVectorElement()) {
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006381 // The operand cannot be an element of a vector
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006382 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
Nate Begemanb104b1f2009-02-15 22:45:20 +00006383 << "vector element" << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffbcb2b612008-02-29 23:30:25 +00006384 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanian0337f212009-07-07 18:50:52 +00006385 } else if (isa<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(op)) {
6386 // cannot take address of a property expression.
6387 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6388 << "property expression" << op->getSourceRange();
6389 return QualType();
Anders Carlsson1d524c32009-09-14 23:15:26 +00006390 } else if (ConditionalOperator *CO = dyn_cast<ConditionalOperator>(op)) {
6391 // FIXME: Can LHS ever be null here?
Anders Carlsson474e1022009-09-15 16:03:44 +00006392 if (!CheckAddressOfOperand(CO->getTrueExpr(), OpLoc).isNull())
6393 return CheckAddressOfOperand(CO->getFalseExpr(), OpLoc);
Steve Naroffbcb2b612008-02-29 23:30:25 +00006394 } else if (dcl) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006395 // We have an lvalue with a decl. Make sure the decl is not declared
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006396 // with the register storage-class specifier.
6397 if (const VarDecl *vd = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(dcl)) {
Fariborz Jahanian4020f872010-08-24 22:21:48 +00006398 // in C++ it is not error to take address of a register
6399 // variable (c++03 7.1.1P3)
John McCalld931b082010-08-26 03:08:43 +00006400 if (vd->getStorageClass() == SC_Register &&
Fariborz Jahanian4020f872010-08-24 22:21:48 +00006401 !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006402 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6403 << "register variable" << op->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006404 return QualType();
6405 }
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006406 } else if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006407 return Context.OverloadTy;
Anders Carlssonf9e48bd2009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006408 } else if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregor29882052008-12-10 21:26:49 +00006409 // Okay: we can take the address of a field.
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006410 // Could be a pointer to member, though, if there is an explicit
6411 // scope qualifier for the class.
Douglas Gregora2813ce2009-10-23 18:54:35 +00006412 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(op) && cast<DeclRefExpr>(op)->getQualifier()) {
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006413 DeclContext *Ctx = dcl->getDeclContext();
Anders Carlssonf9e48bd2009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006414 if (Ctx && Ctx->isRecord()) {
6415 if (FD->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006416 Diag(OpLoc,
Anders Carlssonf9e48bd2009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006417 diag::err_cannot_form_pointer_to_member_of_reference_type)
6418 << FD->getDeclName() << FD->getType();
6419 return QualType();
6420 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006421
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006422 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6423 Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)).getTypePtr());
Anders Carlssonf9e48bd2009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006424 }
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006425 }
Anders Carlsson196f7d02009-05-16 21:43:42 +00006426 } else if (!isa<FunctionDecl>(dcl))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006427 assert(0 && "Unknown/unexpected decl type");
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006428 }
Sebastian Redl33b399a2009-02-04 21:23:32 +00006429
Eli Friedman441cf102009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006430 if (lval == Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
6431 // Taking the address of a void variable is technically illegal, but we
6432 // allow it in cases which are otherwise valid.
6433 // Example: "extern void x; void* y = &x;".
6434 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_void) << op->getSourceRange();
6435 }
6436
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006437 // If the operand has type "type", the result has type "pointer to type".
Douglas Gregor8f70ddb2010-07-29 16:05:45 +00006438 if (op->getType()->isObjCObjectType())
6439 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(op->getType());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006440 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
6441}
6442
Chris Lattnerfd79a9d2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006443/// CheckIndirectionOperand - Type check unary indirection (prefix '*').
Chris Lattner22caddc2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006444QualType Sema::CheckIndirectionOperand(Expr *Op, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006445 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
6446 return Context.DependentTy;
6447
Chris Lattner22caddc2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006448 UsualUnaryConversions(Op);
Chris Lattnerfd79a9d2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006449 QualType OpTy = Op->getType();
6450 QualType Result;
6451
6452 // Note that per both C89 and C99, indirection is always legal, even if OpTy
6453 // is an incomplete type or void. It would be possible to warn about
6454 // dereferencing a void pointer, but it's completely well-defined, and such a
6455 // warning is unlikely to catch any mistakes.
6456 if (const PointerType *PT = OpTy->getAs<PointerType>())
6457 Result = PT->getPointeeType();
6458 else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
6459 OpTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
6460 Result = OPT->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006461
Chris Lattnerfd79a9d2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006462 if (Result.isNull()) {
6463 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_indirection_requires_pointer)
6464 << OpTy << Op->getSourceRange();
6465 return QualType();
6466 }
6467
6468 return Result;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006469}
6470
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006471static inline BinaryOperatorKind ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006472 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006473 BinaryOperatorKind Opc;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006474 switch (Kind) {
6475 default: assert(0 && "Unknown binop!");
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006476 case tok::periodstar: Opc = BO_PtrMemD; break;
6477 case tok::arrowstar: Opc = BO_PtrMemI; break;
6478 case tok::star: Opc = BO_Mul; break;
6479 case tok::slash: Opc = BO_Div; break;
6480 case tok::percent: Opc = BO_Rem; break;
6481 case tok::plus: Opc = BO_Add; break;
6482 case tok::minus: Opc = BO_Sub; break;
6483 case tok::lessless: Opc = BO_Shl; break;
6484 case tok::greatergreater: Opc = BO_Shr; break;
6485 case tok::lessequal: Opc = BO_LE; break;
6486 case tok::less: Opc = BO_LT; break;
6487 case tok::greaterequal: Opc = BO_GE; break;
6488 case tok::greater: Opc = BO_GT; break;
6489 case tok::exclaimequal: Opc = BO_NE; break;
6490 case tok::equalequal: Opc = BO_EQ; break;
6491 case tok::amp: Opc = BO_And; break;
6492 case tok::caret: Opc = BO_Xor; break;
6493 case tok::pipe: Opc = BO_Or; break;
6494 case tok::ampamp: Opc = BO_LAnd; break;
6495 case tok::pipepipe: Opc = BO_LOr; break;
6496 case tok::equal: Opc = BO_Assign; break;
6497 case tok::starequal: Opc = BO_MulAssign; break;
6498 case tok::slashequal: Opc = BO_DivAssign; break;
6499 case tok::percentequal: Opc = BO_RemAssign; break;
6500 case tok::plusequal: Opc = BO_AddAssign; break;
6501 case tok::minusequal: Opc = BO_SubAssign; break;
6502 case tok::lesslessequal: Opc = BO_ShlAssign; break;
6503 case tok::greatergreaterequal: Opc = BO_ShrAssign; break;
6504 case tok::ampequal: Opc = BO_AndAssign; break;
6505 case tok::caretequal: Opc = BO_XorAssign; break;
6506 case tok::pipeequal: Opc = BO_OrAssign; break;
6507 case tok::comma: Opc = BO_Comma; break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006508 }
6509 return Opc;
6510}
6511
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006512static inline UnaryOperatorKind ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006513 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006514 UnaryOperatorKind Opc;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006515 switch (Kind) {
6516 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006517 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UO_PreInc; break;
6518 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UO_PreDec; break;
6519 case tok::amp: Opc = UO_AddrOf; break;
6520 case tok::star: Opc = UO_Deref; break;
6521 case tok::plus: Opc = UO_Plus; break;
6522 case tok::minus: Opc = UO_Minus; break;
6523 case tok::tilde: Opc = UO_Not; break;
6524 case tok::exclaim: Opc = UO_LNot; break;
6525 case tok::kw___real: Opc = UO_Real; break;
6526 case tok::kw___imag: Opc = UO_Imag; break;
6527 case tok::kw___extension__: Opc = UO_Extension; break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006528 }
6529 return Opc;
6530}
6531
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006532/// CreateBuiltinBinOp - Creates a new built-in binary operation with
6533/// operator @p Opc at location @c TokLoc. This routine only supports
6534/// built-in operations; ActOnBinOp handles overloaded operators.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006535ExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006536 unsigned Op,
6537 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006538 QualType ResultTy; // Result type of the binary operator.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006539 BinaryOperatorKind Opc = (BinaryOperatorKind) Op;
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006540 // The following two variables are used for compound assignment operators
6541 QualType CompLHSTy; // Type of LHS after promotions for computation
6542 QualType CompResultTy; // Type of computation result
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006543
6544 switch (Opc) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006545 case BO_Assign:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006546 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, QualType());
6547 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006548 case BO_PtrMemD:
6549 case BO_PtrMemI:
Sebastian Redl22460502009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006550 ResultTy = CheckPointerToMemberOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006551 Opc == BO_PtrMemI);
Sebastian Redl22460502009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006552 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006553 case BO_Mul:
6554 case BO_Div:
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00006555 ResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, false,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006556 Opc == BO_Div);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006557 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006558 case BO_Rem:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006559 ResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6560 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006561 case BO_Add:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006562 ResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6563 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006564 case BO_Sub:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006565 ResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6566 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006567 case BO_Shl:
6568 case BO_Shr:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006569 ResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6570 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006571 case BO_LE:
6572 case BO_LT:
6573 case BO_GE:
6574 case BO_GT:
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006575 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, true);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006576 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006577 case BO_EQ:
6578 case BO_NE:
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006579 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, false);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006580 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006581 case BO_And:
6582 case BO_Xor:
6583 case BO_Or:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006584 ResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6585 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006586 case BO_LAnd:
6587 case BO_LOr:
Chris Lattner90a8f272010-07-13 19:41:32 +00006588 ResultTy = CheckLogicalOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006589 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006590 case BO_MulAssign:
6591 case BO_DivAssign:
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00006592 CompResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006593 Opc == BO_DivAssign);
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006594 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6595 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6596 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006597 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006598 case BO_RemAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006599 CompResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6600 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6601 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6602 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006603 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006604 case BO_AddAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006605 CompResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
6606 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6607 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006608 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006609 case BO_SubAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006610 CompResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
6611 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6612 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006613 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006614 case BO_ShlAssign:
6615 case BO_ShrAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006616 CompResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6617 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6618 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6619 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006620 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006621 case BO_AndAssign:
6622 case BO_XorAssign:
6623 case BO_OrAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006624 CompResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6625 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6626 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6627 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006628 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006629 case BO_Comma:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006630 ResultTy = CheckCommaOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6631 break;
6632 }
6633 if (ResultTy.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006634 return ExprError();
Fariborz Jahanian57dae1a2010-08-16 21:51:12 +00006635 if (ResultTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006636 if (Opc >= BO_Assign && Opc <= BO_OrAssign)
Fariborz Jahanian57dae1a2010-08-16 21:51:12 +00006637 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_assignment_requires_nonfragile_object)
6638 << ResultTy;
6639 }
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006640 if (CompResultTy.isNull())
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006641 return Owned(new (Context) BinaryOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy, OpLoc));
6642 else
6643 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundAssignOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy,
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006644 CompLHSTy, CompResultTy,
6645 OpLoc));
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006646}
6647
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006648/// SuggestParentheses - Emit a diagnostic together with a fixit hint that wraps
6649/// ParenRange in parentheses.
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006650static void SuggestParentheses(Sema &Self, SourceLocation Loc,
6651 const PartialDiagnostic &PD,
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006652 const PartialDiagnostic &FirstNote,
6653 SourceRange FirstParenRange,
6654 const PartialDiagnostic &SecondNote,
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006655 SourceRange SecondParenRange) {
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006656 Self.Diag(Loc, PD);
6657
6658 if (!FirstNote.getDiagID())
6659 return;
6660
6661 SourceLocation EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(FirstParenRange.getEnd());
6662 if (!FirstParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
6663 // We can't display the parentheses, so just return.
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006664 return;
6665 }
6666
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006667 Self.Diag(Loc, FirstNote)
6668 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(FirstParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00006669 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006670
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006671 if (!SecondNote.getDiagID())
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006672 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006673
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006674 EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(SecondParenRange.getEnd());
6675 if (!SecondParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
6676 // We can't display the parentheses, so just dig the
6677 // warning/error and return.
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006678 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondNote);
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006679 return;
6680 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006681
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006682 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondNote)
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00006683 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SecondParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
6684 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006685}
6686
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006687/// DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence - Emit a warning when bitwise and comparison
6688/// operators are mixed in a way that suggests that the programmer forgot that
6689/// comparison operators have higher precedence. The most typical example of
6690/// such code is "flags & 0x0020 != 0", which is equivalent to "flags & 1".
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006691static void DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006692 SourceLocation OpLoc,Expr *lhs,Expr *rhs){
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006693 typedef BinaryOperator BinOp;
6694 BinOp::Opcode lhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1),
6695 rhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1);
6696 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(lhs))
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006697 lhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006698 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(rhs))
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006699 rhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
6700
6701 // Subs are not binary operators.
6702 if (lhsopc == -1 && rhsopc == -1)
6703 return;
6704
6705 // Bitwise operations are sometimes used as eager logical ops.
6706 // Don't diagnose this.
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006707 if ((BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(lhsopc)) &&
6708 (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(rhsopc)))
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006709 return;
6710
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006711 if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc))
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006712 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006713 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006714 << SourceRange(lhs->getLocStart(), OpLoc)
6715 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(lhsopc),
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006716 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006717 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006718 SourceRange(cast<BinOp>(lhs)->getRHS()->getLocStart(), rhs->getLocEnd()),
6719 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_silence)
6720 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(lhsopc),
6721 lhs->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006722 else if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc))
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006723 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006724 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006725 << SourceRange(OpLoc, rhs->getLocEnd())
6726 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(rhsopc),
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006727 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006728 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006729 SourceRange(lhs->getLocEnd(), cast<BinOp>(rhs)->getLHS()->getLocStart()),
6730 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_silence)
6731 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(rhsopc),
6732 rhs->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006733}
6734
6735/// DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence - Emit warnings for expressions with tricky
6736/// precedence. This currently diagnoses only "arg1 'bitwise' arg2 'eq' arg3".
6737/// But it could also warn about arg1 && arg2 || arg3, as GCC 4.3+ does.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006738static void DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006739 SourceLocation OpLoc, Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs){
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006740 if (BinaryOperator::isBitwiseOp(Opc))
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006741 DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Self, Opc, OpLoc, lhs, rhs);
6742}
6743
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006744// Binary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006745ExprResult Sema::ActOnBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation TokLoc,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006746 tok::TokenKind Kind,
6747 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
6748 BinaryOperatorKind Opc = ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(Kind);
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00006749 assert((lhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing left expression");
6750 assert((rhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing right expression");
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006751
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006752 // Emit warnings for tricky precedence issues, e.g. "bitfield & 0x4 == 0"
6753 DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(*this, Opc, TokLoc, lhs, rhs);
6754
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006755 return BuildBinOp(S, TokLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
6756}
6757
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006758ExprResult Sema::BuildBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006759 BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
6760 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006761 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Fariborz Jahanianc4e1a682010-09-14 23:02:38 +00006762 ((!isa<ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr>(lhs) &&
6763 !isa<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(lhs))
Fariborz Jahanianeb17e8b2010-09-17 20:45:45 +00006764 || rhs->isTypeDependent() || Opc != BO_Assign) &&
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006765 (lhs->getType()->isOverloadableType() ||
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006766 rhs->getType()->isOverloadableType())) {
6767 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
6768 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
6769 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
6770 // the arguments.
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006771 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006772 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006773 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
6774 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, lhs->getType(), rhs->getType(),
6775 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006776
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006777 // Build the (potentially-overloaded, potentially-dependent)
6778 // binary operation.
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006779 return CreateOverloadedBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, lhs, rhs);
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006780 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006781
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006782 // Build a built-in binary operation.
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006783 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006784}
6785
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006786ExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006787 unsigned OpcIn,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00006788 Expr *Input) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006789 UnaryOperatorKind Opc = static_cast<UnaryOperatorKind>(OpcIn);
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006790
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006791 QualType resultType;
6792 switch (Opc) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006793 case UO_PreInc:
6794 case UO_PreDec:
6795 case UO_PostInc:
6796 case UO_PostDec:
Sebastian Redle6d5a4a2008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006797 resultType = CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Input, OpLoc,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006798 Opc == UO_PreInc ||
6799 Opc == UO_PostInc,
6800 Opc == UO_PreInc ||
6801 Opc == UO_PreDec);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006802 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006803 case UO_AddrOf:
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006804 resultType = CheckAddressOfOperand(Input, OpLoc);
6805 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006806 case UO_Deref:
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006807 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006808 resultType = CheckIndirectionOperand(Input, OpLoc);
6809 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006810 case UO_Plus:
6811 case UO_Minus:
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006812 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
6813 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006814 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6815 break;
Douglas Gregor00619622010-06-22 23:41:02 +00006816 if (resultType->isArithmeticType() || // C99 6.5.3.3p1
6817 resultType->isVectorType())
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006818 break;
6819 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6-7
6820 resultType->isEnumeralType())
6821 break;
6822 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006823 Opc == UO_Plus &&
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006824 resultType->isPointerType())
6825 break;
6826
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006827 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6828 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006829 case UO_Not: // bitwise complement
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006830 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
6831 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006832 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6833 break;
Chris Lattner02a65142008-07-25 23:52:49 +00006834 // C99 6.5.3.3p1. We allow complex int and float as a GCC extension.
6835 if (resultType->isComplexType() || resultType->isComplexIntegerType())
6836 // C99 does not support '~' for complex conjugation.
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006837 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_complement_complex)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006838 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00006839 else if (!resultType->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006840 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6841 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006842 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006843 case UO_LNot: // logical negation
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006844 // Unlike +/-/~, integer promotions aren't done here (C99 6.5.3.3p5).
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006845 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006846 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006847 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6848 break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006849 if (!resultType->isScalarType()) // C99 6.5.3.3p1
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006850 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6851 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregorea844f32010-09-20 17:13:33 +00006852
6853 // Do not accept &f if f is overloaded
6854 // i.e. void f(int); void f(char); bool b = &f;
6855 if (resultType == Context.OverloadTy &&
6856 PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(Input))
6857 return ExprError(); // Diagnostic is uttered above
6858
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006859 // LNot always has type int. C99 6.5.3.3p5.
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006860 // In C++, it's bool. C++ 5.3.1p8
6861 resultType = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy : Context.IntTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006862 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006863 case UO_Real:
6864 case UO_Imag:
6865 resultType = CheckRealImagOperand(Input, OpLoc, Opc == UO_Real);
Chris Lattnerdbb36972007-08-24 21:16:53 +00006866 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006867 case UO_Extension:
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006868 resultType = Input->getType();
6869 break;
6870 }
6871 if (resultType.isNull())
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006872 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006873
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006874 return Owned(new (Context) UnaryOperator(Input, Opc, resultType, OpLoc));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006875}
6876
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006877ExprResult Sema::BuildUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006878 UnaryOperatorKind Opc,
6879 Expr *Input) {
Anders Carlssona8a1e3d2009-11-14 21:26:41 +00006880 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && Input->getType()->isOverloadableType() &&
Eli Friedman957c0942010-09-05 23:15:52 +00006881 UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc) != OO_None) {
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006882 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
6883 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
6884 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
6885 // the arguments.
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006886 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006887 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006888 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
6889 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, Input->getType(), QualType(),
6890 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006891
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00006892 return CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, Input);
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006893 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006894
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00006895 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input);
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006896}
6897
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006898// Unary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006899ExprResult Sema::ActOnUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00006900 tok::TokenKind Op, Expr *Input) {
6901 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(Op), Input);
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006902}
6903
Steve Naroff1b273c42007-09-16 14:56:35 +00006904/// ActOnAddrLabel - Parse the GNU address of label extension: "&&foo".
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006905ExprResult Sema::ActOnAddrLabel(SourceLocation OpLoc,
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006906 SourceLocation LabLoc,
6907 IdentifierInfo *LabelII) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006908 // Look up the record for this label identifier.
John McCall781472f2010-08-25 08:40:02 +00006909 LabelStmt *&LabelDecl = getCurFunction()->LabelMap[LabelII];
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006910
Daniel Dunbar0ffb1252008-08-04 16:51:22 +00006911 // If we haven't seen this label yet, create a forward reference. It
6912 // will be validated and/or cleaned up in ActOnFinishFunctionBody.
Steve Naroffcaaacec2009-03-13 15:38:40 +00006913 if (LabelDecl == 0)
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006914 LabelDecl = new (Context) LabelStmt(LabLoc, LabelII, 0);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006915
Argyrios Kyrtzidis355a9fe2010-09-19 21:21:25 +00006916 LabelDecl->setUsed();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006917 // Create the AST node. The address of a label always has type 'void*'.
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006918 return Owned(new (Context) AddrLabelExpr(OpLoc, LabLoc, LabelDecl,
6919 Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy)));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006920}
6921
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006922ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00006923Sema::ActOnStmtExpr(SourceLocation LPLoc, Stmt *SubStmt,
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006924 SourceLocation RPLoc) { // "({..})"
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006925 assert(SubStmt && isa<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt) && "Invalid action invocation!");
6926 CompoundStmt *Compound = cast<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt);
6927
Douglas Gregordd8f5692010-03-10 04:54:39 +00006928 bool isFileScope
6929 = (getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0) && (getCurBlock() == 0);
Chris Lattner4a049f02009-04-25 19:11:05 +00006930 if (isFileScope)
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006931 return ExprError(Diag(LPLoc, diag::err_stmtexpr_file_scope));
Eli Friedmandca2b732009-01-24 23:09:00 +00006932
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006933 // FIXME: there are a variety of strange constraints to enforce here, for
6934 // example, it is not possible to goto into a stmt expression apparently.
6935 // More semantic analysis is needed.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006936
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006937 // If there are sub stmts in the compound stmt, take the type of the last one
6938 // as the type of the stmtexpr.
6939 QualType Ty = Context.VoidTy;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006940
Chris Lattner611b2ec2008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006941 if (!Compound->body_empty()) {
6942 Stmt *LastStmt = Compound->body_back();
6943 // If LastStmt is a label, skip down through into the body.
6944 while (LabelStmt *Label = dyn_cast<LabelStmt>(LastStmt))
6945 LastStmt = Label->getSubStmt();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006946
Chris Lattner611b2ec2008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006947 if (Expr *LastExpr = dyn_cast<Expr>(LastStmt))
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006948 Ty = LastExpr->getType();
Chris Lattner611b2ec2008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006949 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006950
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00006951 // FIXME: Check that expression type is complete/non-abstract; statement
6952 // expressions are not lvalues.
6953
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006954 return Owned(new (Context) StmtExpr(Compound, Ty, LPLoc, RPLoc));
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006955}
Steve Naroffd34e9152007-08-01 22:05:33 +00006956
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006957ExprResult Sema::BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006958 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006959 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
6960 unsigned NumComponents,
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006961 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
6962 QualType ArgTy = TInfo->getType();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006963 bool Dependent = ArgTy->isDependentType();
Abramo Bagnarabd054db2010-05-20 10:00:11 +00006964 SourceRange TypeRange = TInfo->getTypeLoc().getLocalSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006965
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006966 // We must have at least one component that refers to the type, and the first
6967 // one is known to be a field designator. Verify that the ArgTy represents
6968 // a struct/union/class.
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006969 if (!Dependent && !ArgTy->isRecordType())
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006970 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
6971 << ArgTy << TypeRange);
6972
6973 // Type must be complete per C99 7.17p3 because a declaring a variable
6974 // with an incomplete type would be ill-formed.
6975 if (!Dependent
6976 && RequireCompleteType(BuiltinLoc, ArgTy,
6977 PDiag(diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type)
6978 << TypeRange))
6979 return ExprError();
6980
Chris Lattner9e2b75c2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00006981 // offsetof with non-identifier designators (e.g. "offsetof(x, a.b[c])") are a
6982 // GCC extension, diagnose them.
Eli Friedman35183ac2009-02-27 06:44:11 +00006983 // FIXME: This diagnostic isn't actually visible because the location is in
6984 // a system header!
Chris Lattner9e2b75c2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00006985 if (NumComponents != 1)
Chris Lattnerdcd5ef12008-11-19 05:27:50 +00006986 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::ext_offsetof_extended_field_designator)
6987 << SourceRange(CompPtr[1].LocStart, CompPtr[NumComponents-1].LocEnd);
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006988
6989 bool DidWarnAboutNonPOD = false;
6990 QualType CurrentType = ArgTy;
6991 typedef OffsetOfExpr::OffsetOfNode OffsetOfNode;
6992 llvm::SmallVector<OffsetOfNode, 4> Comps;
6993 llvm::SmallVector<Expr*, 4> Exprs;
6994 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumComponents; ++i) {
6995 const OffsetOfComponent &OC = CompPtr[i];
6996 if (OC.isBrackets) {
6997 // Offset of an array sub-field. TODO: Should we allow vector elements?
6998 if (!CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
6999 const ArrayType *AT = Context.getAsArrayType(CurrentType);
7000 if(!AT)
7001 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_array_type)
7002 << CurrentType);
7003 CurrentType = AT->getElementType();
7004 } else
7005 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
7006
7007 // The expression must be an integral expression.
7008 // FIXME: An integral constant expression?
7009 Expr *Idx = static_cast<Expr*>(OC.U.E);
7010 if (!Idx->isTypeDependent() && !Idx->isValueDependent() &&
7011 !Idx->getType()->isIntegerType())
7012 return ExprError(Diag(Idx->getLocStart(),
7013 diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
7014 << Idx->getSourceRange());
7015
7016 // Record this array index.
7017 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Exprs.size(), OC.LocEnd));
7018 Exprs.push_back(Idx);
7019 continue;
7020 }
7021
7022 // Offset of a field.
7023 if (CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
7024 // We have the offset of a field, but we can't look into the dependent
7025 // type. Just record the identifier of the field.
7026 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocEnd));
7027 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
7028 continue;
7029 }
7030
7031 // We need to have a complete type to look into.
7032 if (RequireCompleteType(OC.LocStart, CurrentType,
7033 diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type))
7034 return ExprError();
7035
7036 // Look for the designated field.
7037 const RecordType *RC = CurrentType->getAs<RecordType>();
7038 if (!RC)
7039 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
7040 << CurrentType);
7041 RecordDecl *RD = RC->getDecl();
7042
7043 // C++ [lib.support.types]p5:
7044 // The macro offsetof accepts a restricted set of type arguments in this
7045 // International Standard. type shall be a POD structure or a POD union
7046 // (clause 9).
7047 if (CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) {
7048 if (!CRD->isPOD() && !DidWarnAboutNonPOD &&
7049 DiagRuntimeBehavior(BuiltinLoc,
7050 PDiag(diag::warn_offsetof_non_pod_type)
7051 << SourceRange(CompPtr[0].LocStart, OC.LocEnd)
7052 << CurrentType))
7053 DidWarnAboutNonPOD = true;
7054 }
7055
7056 // Look for the field.
7057 LookupResult R(*this, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocStart, LookupMemberName);
7058 LookupQualifiedName(R, RD);
7059 FieldDecl *MemberDecl = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>();
7060 if (!MemberDecl)
7061 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_no_member)
7062 << OC.U.IdentInfo << RD << SourceRange(OC.LocStart,
7063 OC.LocEnd));
7064
Douglas Gregor9d5d60f2010-04-28 22:36:06 +00007065 // C99 7.17p3:
7066 // (If the specified member is a bit-field, the behavior is undefined.)
7067 //
7068 // We diagnose this as an error.
7069 if (MemberDecl->getBitWidth()) {
7070 Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_bitfield)
7071 << MemberDecl->getDeclName()
7072 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RParenLoc);
7073 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_bitfield_decl);
7074 return ExprError();
7075 }
Eli Friedman19410a72010-08-05 10:11:36 +00007076
7077 RecordDecl *Parent = MemberDecl->getParent();
7078 bool AnonStructUnion = Parent->isAnonymousStructOrUnion();
7079 if (AnonStructUnion) {
7080 do {
7081 Parent = cast<RecordDecl>(Parent->getParent());
7082 } while (Parent->isAnonymousStructOrUnion());
7083 }
7084
Douglas Gregorcc8a5d52010-04-29 00:18:15 +00007085 // If the member was found in a base class, introduce OffsetOfNodes for
7086 // the base class indirections.
7087 CXXBasePaths Paths(/*FindAmbiguities=*/true, /*RecordPaths=*/true,
7088 /*DetectVirtual=*/false);
Eli Friedman19410a72010-08-05 10:11:36 +00007089 if (IsDerivedFrom(CurrentType, Context.getTypeDeclType(Parent), Paths)) {
Douglas Gregorcc8a5d52010-04-29 00:18:15 +00007090 CXXBasePath &Path = Paths.front();
7091 for (CXXBasePath::iterator B = Path.begin(), BEnd = Path.end();
7092 B != BEnd; ++B)
7093 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(B->Base));
7094 }
Eli Friedman19410a72010-08-05 10:11:36 +00007095
7096 if (AnonStructUnion) {
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007097 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl*, 4> Path;
7098 BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(MemberDecl, Path);
7099 unsigned n = Path.size();
7100 for (int j = n - 1; j > -1; --j)
7101 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Path[j], OC.LocEnd));
7102 } else {
7103 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, MemberDecl, OC.LocEnd));
7104 }
7105 CurrentType = MemberDecl->getType().getNonReferenceType();
7106 }
7107
7108 return Owned(OffsetOfExpr::Create(Context, Context.getSizeType(), BuiltinLoc,
7109 TInfo, Comps.data(), Comps.size(),
7110 Exprs.data(), Exprs.size(), RParenLoc));
7111}
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007112
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007113ExprResult Sema::ActOnBuiltinOffsetOf(Scope *S,
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007114 SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7115 SourceLocation TypeLoc,
John McCallb3d87482010-08-24 05:47:05 +00007116 ParsedType argty,
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007117 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
7118 unsigned NumComponents,
7119 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
7120
7121 TypeSourceInfo *ArgTInfo;
7122 QualType ArgTy = GetTypeFromParser(argty, &ArgTInfo);
7123 if (ArgTy.isNull())
7124 return ExprError();
7125
Eli Friedman5a15dc12010-08-05 10:15:45 +00007126 if (!ArgTInfo)
7127 ArgTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(ArgTy, TypeLoc);
7128
7129 return BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(BuiltinLoc, ArgTInfo, CompPtr, NumComponents,
7130 RPLoc);
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00007131}
7132
7133
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007134ExprResult Sema::ActOnTypesCompatibleExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCallb3d87482010-08-24 05:47:05 +00007135 ParsedType arg1,ParsedType arg2,
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007136 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Abramo Bagnara3fcb73d2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007137 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo1;
7138 QualType argT1 = GetTypeFromParser(arg1, &argTInfo1);
7139 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo2;
7140 QualType argT2 = GetTypeFromParser(arg2, &argTInfo2);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007141
Steve Naroffd34e9152007-08-01 22:05:33 +00007142 assert((!argT1.isNull() && !argT2.isNull()) && "Missing type argument(s)");
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007143
Abramo Bagnara3fcb73d2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007144 return BuildTypesCompatibleExpr(BuiltinLoc, argTInfo1, argTInfo2, RPLoc);
7145}
7146
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007147ExprResult
Abramo Bagnara3fcb73d2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007148Sema::BuildTypesCompatibleExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7149 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo1,
7150 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo2,
7151 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Douglas Gregorc12a9c52009-05-19 22:28:02 +00007152 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
7153 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_types_compatible_p_in_cplusplus)
7154 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RPLoc);
7155 return ExprError();
7156 }
7157
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007158 return Owned(new (Context) TypesCompatibleExpr(Context.IntTy, BuiltinLoc,
Abramo Bagnara3fcb73d2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007159 argTInfo1, argTInfo2, RPLoc));
Steve Naroffd34e9152007-08-01 22:05:33 +00007160}
7161
Abramo Bagnara3fcb73d2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007162
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007163ExprResult Sema::ActOnChooseExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007164 Expr *CondExpr,
7165 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr,
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007166 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Steve Naroffd04fdd52007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007167 assert((CondExpr && LHSExpr && RHSExpr) && "Missing type argument(s)");
7168
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007169 QualType resType;
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007170 bool ValueDependent = false;
Douglas Gregorc9ecc572009-05-19 22:43:30 +00007171 if (CondExpr->isTypeDependent() || CondExpr->isValueDependent()) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007172 resType = Context.DependentTy;
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007173 ValueDependent = true;
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007174 } else {
7175 // The conditional expression is required to be a constant expression.
7176 llvm::APSInt condEval(32);
7177 SourceLocation ExpLoc;
7178 if (!CondExpr->isIntegerConstantExpr(condEval, Context, &ExpLoc))
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007179 return ExprError(Diag(ExpLoc,
7180 diag::err_typecheck_choose_expr_requires_constant)
7181 << CondExpr->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroffd04fdd52007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007182
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007183 // If the condition is > zero, then the AST type is the same as the LSHExpr.
7184 resType = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr->getType() : RHSExpr->getType();
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007185 ValueDependent = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr->isValueDependent()
7186 : RHSExpr->isValueDependent();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007187 }
7188
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007189 return Owned(new (Context) ChooseExpr(BuiltinLoc, CondExpr, LHSExpr, RHSExpr,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007190 resType, RPLoc,
7191 resType->isDependentType(),
7192 ValueDependent));
Steve Naroffd04fdd52007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007193}
7194
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007195//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7196// Clang Extensions.
7197//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7198
7199/// ActOnBlockStart - This callback is invoked when a block literal is started.
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007200void Sema::ActOnBlockStart(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *BlockScope) {
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007201 BlockDecl *Block = BlockDecl::Create(Context, CurContext, CaretLoc);
7202 PushBlockScope(BlockScope, Block);
7203 CurContext->addDecl(Block);
Fariborz Jahaniana729da22010-07-09 18:44:02 +00007204 if (BlockScope)
7205 PushDeclContext(BlockScope, Block);
7206 else
7207 CurContext = Block;
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007208}
7209
Mike Stump98eb8a72009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007210void Sema::ActOnBlockArguments(Declarator &ParamInfo, Scope *CurScope) {
Mike Stumpaf199f32009-05-07 18:43:07 +00007211 assert(ParamInfo.getIdentifier()==0 && "block-id should have no identifier!");
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007212 BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock = getCurBlock();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007213
John McCallbf1a0282010-06-04 23:28:52 +00007214 TypeSourceInfo *Sig = GetTypeForDeclarator(ParamInfo, CurScope);
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007215 CurBlock->TheDecl->setSignatureAsWritten(Sig);
John McCallbf1a0282010-06-04 23:28:52 +00007216 QualType T = Sig->getType();
Mike Stump98eb8a72009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007217
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007218 bool isVariadic;
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007219 QualType RetTy;
7220 if (const FunctionType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionType>()) {
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007221 CurBlock->FunctionType = T;
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007222 RetTy = Fn->getResultType();
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007223 isVariadic =
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007224 !isa<FunctionProtoType>(Fn) || cast<FunctionProtoType>(Fn)->isVariadic();
7225 } else {
7226 RetTy = T;
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007227 isVariadic = false;
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007228 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007229
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007230 CurBlock->TheDecl->setIsVariadic(isVariadic);
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00007231
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007232 // Don't allow returning an array by value.
7233 if (RetTy->isArrayType()) {
7234 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(), diag::err_block_returns_array);
Mike Stump98eb8a72009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007235 return;
7236 }
7237
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007238 // Don't allow returning a objc interface by value.
7239 if (RetTy->isObjCObjectType()) {
7240 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7241 diag::err_object_cannot_be_passed_returned_by_value) << 0 << RetTy;
7242 return;
7243 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007244
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007245 // Context.DependentTy is used as a placeholder for a missing block
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007246 // return type. TODO: what should we do with declarators like:
7247 // ^ * { ... }
7248 // If the answer is "apply template argument deduction"....
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007249 if (RetTy != Context.DependentTy)
7250 CurBlock->ReturnType = RetTy;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007251
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007252 // Push block parameters from the declarator if we had them.
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007253 llvm::SmallVector<ParmVarDecl*, 8> Params;
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007254 if (isa<FunctionProtoType>(T)) {
7255 FunctionProtoTypeLoc TL = cast<FunctionProtoTypeLoc>(Sig->getTypeLoc());
7256 for (unsigned I = 0, E = TL.getNumArgs(); I != E; ++I) {
7257 ParmVarDecl *Param = TL.getArg(I);
Fariborz Jahanian9a66c302010-02-12 21:53:14 +00007258 if (Param->getIdentifier() == 0 &&
7259 !Param->isImplicit() &&
7260 !Param->isInvalidDecl() &&
7261 !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
7262 Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_parameter_name_omitted);
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007263 Params.push_back(Param);
Fariborz Jahanian9a66c302010-02-12 21:53:14 +00007264 }
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007265
7266 // Fake up parameter variables if we have a typedef, like
7267 // ^ fntype { ... }
7268 } else if (const FunctionProtoType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
7269 for (FunctionProtoType::arg_type_iterator
7270 I = Fn->arg_type_begin(), E = Fn->arg_type_end(); I != E; ++I) {
7271 ParmVarDecl *Param =
7272 BuildParmVarDeclForTypedef(CurBlock->TheDecl,
7273 ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7274 *I);
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007275 Params.push_back(Param);
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007276 }
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007277 }
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007278
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007279 // Set the parameters on the block decl.
7280 if (!Params.empty())
7281 CurBlock->TheDecl->setParams(Params.data(), Params.size());
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007282
7283 // Finally we can process decl attributes.
Douglas Gregor9cdda0c2009-06-17 21:51:59 +00007284 ProcessDeclAttributes(CurScope, CurBlock->TheDecl, ParamInfo);
John McCall053f4bd2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007285
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007286 if (!isVariadic && CurBlock->TheDecl->getAttr<SentinelAttr>()) {
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007287 Diag(ParamInfo.getAttributes()->getLoc(),
7288 diag::warn_attribute_sentinel_not_variadic) << 1;
7289 // FIXME: remove the attribute.
7290 }
7291
7292 // Put the parameter variables in scope. We can bail out immediately
7293 // if we don't have any.
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007294 if (Params.empty())
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007295 return;
7296
John McCall053f4bd2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007297 bool ShouldCheckShadow =
7298 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::warn_decl_shadow) != Diagnostic::Ignored;
7299
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007300 for (BlockDecl::param_iterator AI = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_begin(),
John McCall7a9813c2010-01-22 00:28:27 +00007301 E = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_end(); AI != E; ++AI) {
7302 (*AI)->setOwningFunction(CurBlock->TheDecl);
7303
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007304 // If this has an identifier, add it to the scope stack.
John McCall053f4bd2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007305 if ((*AI)->getIdentifier()) {
7306 if (ShouldCheckShadow)
7307 CheckShadow(CurBlock->TheScope, *AI);
7308
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007309 PushOnScopeChains(*AI, CurBlock->TheScope);
John McCall053f4bd2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007310 }
John McCall7a9813c2010-01-22 00:28:27 +00007311 }
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007312}
7313
7314/// ActOnBlockError - If there is an error parsing a block, this callback
7315/// is invoked to pop the information about the block from the action impl.
7316void Sema::ActOnBlockError(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *CurScope) {
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007317 // Pop off CurBlock, handle nested blocks.
Chris Lattner5c59e2b2009-04-21 22:38:46 +00007318 PopDeclContext();
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007319 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007320 // FIXME: Delete the ParmVarDecl objects as well???
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007321}
7322
7323/// ActOnBlockStmtExpr - This is called when the body of a block statement
7324/// literal was successfully completed. ^(int x){...}
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007325ExprResult Sema::ActOnBlockStmtExpr(SourceLocation CaretLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007326 Stmt *Body, Scope *CurScope) {
Chris Lattner9af55002009-03-27 04:18:06 +00007327 // If blocks are disabled, emit an error.
7328 if (!LangOpts.Blocks)
7329 Diag(CaretLoc, diag::err_blocks_disable);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007330
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007331 BlockScopeInfo *BSI = cast<BlockScopeInfo>(FunctionScopes.back());
Fariborz Jahaniana729da22010-07-09 18:44:02 +00007332
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007333 PopDeclContext();
7334
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007335 QualType RetTy = Context.VoidTy;
Fariborz Jahanian7d5c74e2009-06-19 23:37:08 +00007336 if (!BSI->ReturnType.isNull())
7337 RetTy = BSI->ReturnType;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007338
Mike Stump56925862009-07-28 22:04:01 +00007339 bool NoReturn = BSI->TheDecl->getAttr<NoReturnAttr>();
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007340 QualType BlockTy;
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007341
7342 // If the user wrote a function type in some form, try to use that.
7343 if (!BSI->FunctionType.isNull()) {
7344 const FunctionType *FTy = BSI->FunctionType->getAs<FunctionType>();
7345
7346 FunctionType::ExtInfo Ext = FTy->getExtInfo();
7347 if (NoReturn && !Ext.getNoReturn()) Ext = Ext.withNoReturn(true);
7348
7349 // Turn protoless block types into nullary block types.
7350 if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FTy)) {
7351 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, 0, 0, false, 0,
7352 false, false, 0, 0, Ext);
7353
7354 // Otherwise, if we don't need to change anything about the function type,
7355 // preserve its sugar structure.
7356 } else if (FTy->getResultType() == RetTy &&
7357 (!NoReturn || FTy->getNoReturnAttr())) {
7358 BlockTy = BSI->FunctionType;
7359
7360 // Otherwise, make the minimal modifications to the function type.
7361 } else {
7362 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(FTy);
7363 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy,
7364 FPT->arg_type_begin(),
7365 FPT->getNumArgs(),
7366 FPT->isVariadic(),
7367 /*quals*/ 0,
7368 FPT->hasExceptionSpec(),
7369 FPT->hasAnyExceptionSpec(),
7370 FPT->getNumExceptions(),
7371 FPT->exception_begin(),
7372 Ext);
7373 }
7374
7375 // If we don't have a function type, just build one from nothing.
7376 } else {
7377 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, 0, 0, false, 0,
7378 false, false, 0, 0,
7379 FunctionType::ExtInfo(NoReturn, 0, CC_Default));
7380 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007381
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007382 // FIXME: Check that return/parameter types are complete/non-abstract
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007383 DiagnoseUnusedParameters(BSI->TheDecl->param_begin(),
7384 BSI->TheDecl->param_end());
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007385 BlockTy = Context.getBlockPointerType(BlockTy);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007386
Chris Lattner17a78302009-04-19 05:28:12 +00007387 // If needed, diagnose invalid gotos and switches in the block.
John McCall781472f2010-08-25 08:40:02 +00007388 if (getCurFunction()->NeedsScopeChecking() && !hasAnyErrorsInThisFunction())
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007389 DiagnoseInvalidJumps(cast<CompoundStmt>(Body));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007390
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007391 BSI->TheDecl->setBody(cast<CompoundStmt>(Body));
Mike Stumpa3899eb2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007392
7393 bool Good = true;
7394 // Check goto/label use.
7395 for (llvm::DenseMap<IdentifierInfo*, LabelStmt*>::iterator
7396 I = BSI->LabelMap.begin(), E = BSI->LabelMap.end(); I != E; ++I) {
7397 LabelStmt *L = I->second;
7398
7399 // Verify that we have no forward references left. If so, there was a goto
7400 // or address of a label taken, but no definition of it.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis355a9fe2010-09-19 21:21:25 +00007401 if (L->getSubStmt() != 0) {
7402 if (!L->isUsed())
7403 Diag(L->getIdentLoc(), diag::warn_unused_label) << L->getName();
Mike Stumpa3899eb2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007404 continue;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis355a9fe2010-09-19 21:21:25 +00007405 }
Mike Stumpa3899eb2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007406
7407 // Emit error.
7408 Diag(L->getIdentLoc(), diag::err_undeclared_label_use) << L->getName();
7409 Good = false;
7410 }
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007411 if (!Good) {
7412 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Mike Stumpa3899eb2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007413 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007414 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007415
John McCalle0054f62010-08-25 05:56:39 +00007416 BlockExpr *Result = new (Context) BlockExpr(BSI->TheDecl, BlockTy,
7417 BSI->hasBlockDeclRefExprs);
7418
Ted Kremenekdbdbaaf2010-03-20 21:06:02 +00007419 // Issue any analysis-based warnings.
Ted Kremenekd064fdc2010-03-23 00:13:23 +00007420 const sema::AnalysisBasedWarnings::Policy &WP =
7421 AnalysisWarnings.getDefaultPolicy();
John McCalle0054f62010-08-25 05:56:39 +00007422 AnalysisWarnings.IssueWarnings(WP, Result);
Ted Kremenekdbdbaaf2010-03-20 21:06:02 +00007423
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007424 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007425 return Owned(Result);
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007426}
7427
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007428ExprResult Sema::ActOnVAArg(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCallb3d87482010-08-24 05:47:05 +00007429 Expr *expr, ParsedType type,
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007430 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Abramo Bagnara2cad9002010-08-10 10:06:15 +00007431 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
7432 QualType T = GetTypeFromParser(type, &TInfo);
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007433 return BuildVAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, expr, TInfo, RPLoc);
Abramo Bagnara2cad9002010-08-10 10:06:15 +00007434}
7435
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007436ExprResult Sema::BuildVAArgExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007437 Expr *E, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
Abramo Bagnara2cad9002010-08-10 10:06:15 +00007438 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Chris Lattner0d20b8a2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00007439 Expr *OrigExpr = E;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007440
Anders Carlsson7c50aca2007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007441 InitBuiltinVaListType();
Eli Friedmanc34bcde2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007442
7443 // Get the va_list type
7444 QualType VaListType = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
Eli Friedman5c091ba2009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007445 if (VaListType->isArrayType()) {
7446 // Deal with implicit array decay; for example, on x86-64,
7447 // va_list is an array, but it's supposed to decay to
7448 // a pointer for va_arg.
Eli Friedmanc34bcde2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007449 VaListType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(VaListType);
Eli Friedman5c091ba2009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007450 // Make sure the input expression also decays appropriately.
7451 UsualUnaryConversions(E);
7452 } else {
7453 // Otherwise, the va_list argument must be an l-value because
7454 // it is modified by va_arg.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007455 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
Douglas Gregordd027302009-05-19 23:10:31 +00007456 CheckForModifiableLvalue(E, BuiltinLoc, *this))
Eli Friedman5c091ba2009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007457 return ExprError();
7458 }
Eli Friedmanc34bcde2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007459
Douglas Gregordd027302009-05-19 23:10:31 +00007460 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
7461 !Context.hasSameType(VaListType, E->getType())) {
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007462 return ExprError(Diag(E->getLocStart(),
7463 diag::err_first_argument_to_va_arg_not_of_type_va_list)
Chris Lattner0d20b8a2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00007464 << OrigExpr->getType() << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner9dc8f192009-04-05 00:59:53 +00007465 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007466
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007467 // FIXME: Check that type is complete/non-abstract
Anders Carlsson7c50aca2007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007468 // FIXME: Warn if a non-POD type is passed in.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007469
Abramo Bagnara2cad9002010-08-10 10:06:15 +00007470 QualType T = TInfo->getType().getNonLValueExprType(Context);
7471 return Owned(new (Context) VAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, E, TInfo, RPLoc, T));
Anders Carlsson7c50aca2007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007472}
7473
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007474ExprResult Sema::ActOnGNUNullExpr(SourceLocation TokenLoc) {
Douglas Gregor2d8b2732008-11-29 04:51:27 +00007475 // The type of __null will be int or long, depending on the size of
7476 // pointers on the target.
7477 QualType Ty;
7478 if (Context.Target.getPointerWidth(0) == Context.Target.getIntWidth())
7479 Ty = Context.IntTy;
7480 else
7481 Ty = Context.LongTy;
7482
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007483 return Owned(new (Context) GNUNullExpr(Ty, TokenLoc));
Douglas Gregor2d8b2732008-11-29 04:51:27 +00007484}
7485
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007486static void MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(Sema& SemaRef, QualType DstType,
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007487 Expr *SrcExpr, FixItHint &Hint) {
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007488 if (!SemaRef.getLangOptions().ObjC1)
7489 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007490
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007491 const ObjCObjectPointerType *PT = DstType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
7492 if (!PT)
7493 return;
7494
7495 // Check if the destination is of type 'id'.
7496 if (!PT->isObjCIdType()) {
7497 // Check if the destination is the 'NSString' interface.
7498 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = PT->getInterfaceDecl();
7499 if (!ID || !ID->getIdentifier()->isStr("NSString"))
7500 return;
7501 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007502
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007503 // Strip off any parens and casts.
7504 StringLiteral *SL = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(SrcExpr->IgnoreParenCasts());
7505 if (!SL || SL->isWide())
7506 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007507
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007508 Hint = FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SL->getLocStart(), "@");
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007509}
7510
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007511bool Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentResult(AssignConvertType ConvTy,
7512 SourceLocation Loc,
7513 QualType DstType, QualType SrcType,
Douglas Gregora41a8c52010-04-22 00:20:18 +00007514 Expr *SrcExpr, AssignmentAction Action,
7515 bool *Complained) {
7516 if (Complained)
7517 *Complained = false;
7518
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007519 // Decode the result (notice that AST's are still created for extensions).
7520 bool isInvalid = false;
7521 unsigned DiagKind;
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007522 FixItHint Hint;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007523
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007524 switch (ConvTy) {
7525 default: assert(0 && "Unknown conversion type");
7526 case Compatible: return false;
Chris Lattnerb7b61152008-01-04 18:22:42 +00007527 case PointerToInt:
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007528 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_int;
7529 break;
Chris Lattnerb7b61152008-01-04 18:22:42 +00007530 case IntToPointer:
7531 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_int_pointer;
7532 break;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007533 case IncompatiblePointer:
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007534 MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(*this, DstType, SrcExpr, Hint);
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007535 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer;
7536 break;
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00007537 case IncompatiblePointerSign:
7538 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer_sign;
7539 break;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007540 case FunctionVoidPointer:
7541 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_void_func;
7542 break;
7543 case CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers:
Douglas Gregor77a52232008-09-12 00:47:35 +00007544 // If the qualifiers lost were because we were applying the
7545 // (deprecated) C++ conversion from a string literal to a char*
7546 // (or wchar_t*), then there was no error (C++ 4.2p2). FIXME:
7547 // Ideally, this check would be performed in
7548 // CheckPointerTypesForAssignment. However, that would require a
7549 // bit of refactoring (so that the second argument is an
7550 // expression, rather than a type), which should be done as part
7551 // of a larger effort to fix CheckPointerTypesForAssignment for
7552 // C++ semantics.
7553 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
7554 IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(SrcExpr, DstType))
7555 return false;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007556 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_discards_qualifiers;
7557 break;
Sean Huntc9132b62009-11-08 07:46:34 +00007558 case IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers:
Fariborz Jahanian3451e922009-11-09 22:16:37 +00007559 DiagKind = diag::ext_nested_pointer_qualifier_mismatch;
Fariborz Jahanian36a862f2009-11-07 20:20:40 +00007560 break;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00007561 case IntToBlockPointer:
7562 DiagKind = diag::err_int_to_block_pointer;
7563 break;
7564 case IncompatibleBlockPointer:
Mike Stump25efa102009-04-21 22:51:42 +00007565 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible_block_pointer;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00007566 break;
Steve Naroff39579072008-10-14 22:18:38 +00007567 case IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId:
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007568 // FIXME: Diagnose the problem in ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible, since
Steve Naroff39579072008-10-14 22:18:38 +00007569 // it can give a more specific diagnostic.
7570 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_qualified_id;
7571 break;
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00007572 case IncompatibleVectors:
7573 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_vectors;
7574 break;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007575 case Incompatible:
7576 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible;
7577 isInvalid = true;
7578 break;
7579 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007580
Douglas Gregord4eea832010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007581 QualType FirstType, SecondType;
7582 switch (Action) {
7583 case AA_Assigning:
7584 case AA_Initializing:
7585 // The destination type comes first.
7586 FirstType = DstType;
7587 SecondType = SrcType;
7588 break;
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007589
Douglas Gregord4eea832010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007590 case AA_Returning:
7591 case AA_Passing:
7592 case AA_Converting:
7593 case AA_Sending:
7594 case AA_Casting:
7595 // The source type comes first.
7596 FirstType = SrcType;
7597 SecondType = DstType;
7598 break;
7599 }
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007600
Douglas Gregord4eea832010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007601 Diag(Loc, DiagKind) << FirstType << SecondType << Action
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007602 << SrcExpr->getSourceRange() << Hint;
Douglas Gregora41a8c52010-04-22 00:20:18 +00007603 if (Complained)
7604 *Complained = true;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007605 return isInvalid;
7606}
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007607
Chris Lattner3bf68932009-04-25 21:59:05 +00007608bool Sema::VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(const Expr *E, llvm::APSInt *Result){
Eli Friedman3b5ccca2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007609 llvm::APSInt ICEResult;
7610 if (E->isIntegerConstantExpr(ICEResult, Context)) {
7611 if (Result)
7612 *Result = ICEResult;
7613 return false;
7614 }
7615
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007616 Expr::EvalResult EvalResult;
7617
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007618 if (!E->Evaluate(EvalResult, Context) || !EvalResult.Val.isInt() ||
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007619 EvalResult.HasSideEffects) {
7620 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_expr_not_ice) << E->getSourceRange();
7621
7622 if (EvalResult.Diag) {
7623 // We only show the note if it's not the usual "invalid subexpression"
7624 // or if it's actually in a subexpression.
7625 if (EvalResult.Diag != diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_ice ||
7626 E->IgnoreParens() != EvalResult.DiagExpr->IgnoreParens())
7627 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
7628 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007629
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007630 return true;
7631 }
7632
Eli Friedman3b5ccca2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007633 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::ext_expr_not_ice) <<
7634 E->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007635
Eli Friedman3b5ccca2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007636 if (EvalResult.Diag &&
7637 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::ext_expr_not_ice) != Diagnostic::Ignored)
7638 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007639
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007640 if (Result)
7641 *Result = EvalResult.Val.getInt();
7642 return false;
7643}
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007644
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007645void
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007646Sema::PushExpressionEvaluationContext(ExpressionEvaluationContext NewContext) {
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007647 ExprEvalContexts.push_back(
7648 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord(NewContext, ExprTemporaries.size()));
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007649}
7650
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007651void
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007652Sema::PopExpressionEvaluationContext() {
7653 // Pop the current expression evaluation context off the stack.
7654 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord Rec = ExprEvalContexts.back();
7655 ExprEvalContexts.pop_back();
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007656
Douglas Gregor06d33692009-12-12 07:57:52 +00007657 if (Rec.Context == PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated) {
7658 if (Rec.PotentiallyReferenced) {
7659 // Mark any remaining declarations in the current position of the stack
7660 // as "referenced". If they were not meant to be referenced, semantic
7661 // analysis would have eliminated them (e.g., in ActOnCXXTypeId).
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007662 for (PotentiallyReferencedDecls::iterator
Douglas Gregor06d33692009-12-12 07:57:52 +00007663 I = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->begin(),
7664 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->end();
7665 I != IEnd; ++I)
7666 MarkDeclarationReferenced(I->first, I->second);
7667 }
7668
7669 if (Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed) {
7670 // Emit any pending diagnostics.
7671 for (PotentiallyEmittedDiagnostics::iterator
7672 I = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->begin(),
7673 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->end();
7674 I != IEnd; ++I)
7675 Diag(I->first, I->second);
7676 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007677 }
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007678
7679 // When are coming out of an unevaluated context, clear out any
7680 // temporaries that we may have created as part of the evaluation of
7681 // the expression in that context: they aren't relevant because they
7682 // will never be constructed.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007683 if (Rec.Context == Unevaluated &&
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007684 ExprTemporaries.size() > Rec.NumTemporaries)
7685 ExprTemporaries.erase(ExprTemporaries.begin() + Rec.NumTemporaries,
7686 ExprTemporaries.end());
7687
7688 // Destroy the popped expression evaluation record.
7689 Rec.Destroy();
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007690}
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007691
7692/// \brief Note that the given declaration was referenced in the source code.
7693///
7694/// This routine should be invoke whenever a given declaration is referenced
7695/// in the source code, and where that reference occurred. If this declaration
7696/// reference means that the the declaration is used (C++ [basic.def.odr]p2,
7697/// C99 6.9p3), then the declaration will be marked as used.
7698///
7699/// \param Loc the location where the declaration was referenced.
7700///
7701/// \param D the declaration that has been referenced by the source code.
7702void Sema::MarkDeclarationReferenced(SourceLocation Loc, Decl *D) {
7703 assert(D && "No declaration?");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007704
Douglas Gregorc070cc62010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007705 if (D->isUsed(false))
Douglas Gregord7f37bf2009-06-22 23:06:13 +00007706 return;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007707
Douglas Gregorb5352cf2009-10-08 21:35:42 +00007708 // Mark a parameter or variable declaration "used", regardless of whether we're in a
7709 // template or not. The reason for this is that unevaluated expressions
7710 // (e.g. (void)sizeof()) constitute a use for warning purposes (-Wunused-variables and
7711 // -Wunused-parameters)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007712 if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(D) ||
Douglas Gregorfc2ca562010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007713 (isa<VarDecl>(D) && D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())) {
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007714 D->setUsed(true);
Douglas Gregorfc2ca562010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007715 return;
7716 }
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007717
Douglas Gregorfc2ca562010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007718 if (!isa<VarDecl>(D) && !isa<FunctionDecl>(D))
7719 return;
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007720
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007721 // Do not mark anything as "used" within a dependent context; wait for
7722 // an instantiation.
7723 if (CurContext->isDependentContext())
7724 return;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007725
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007726 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context) {
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007727 case Unevaluated:
7728 // We are in an expression that is not potentially evaluated; do nothing.
7729 return;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007730
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007731 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
7732 // We are in a potentially-evaluated expression, so this declaration is
7733 // "used"; handle this below.
7734 break;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007735
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007736 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
7737 // We are in an expression that may be potentially evaluated; queue this
7738 // declaration reference until we know whether the expression is
7739 // potentially evaluated.
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007740 ExprEvalContexts.back().addReferencedDecl(Loc, D);
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007741 return;
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00007742
7743 case PotentiallyEvaluatedIfUsed:
7744 // Referenced declarations will only be used if the construct in the
7745 // containing expression is used.
7746 return;
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007747 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007748
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007749 // Note that this declaration has been used.
Fariborz Jahanianb7f4cc02009-06-22 17:30:33 +00007750 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian485f0872009-06-22 23:34:40 +00007751 unsigned TypeQuals;
Fariborz Jahanian05a5c452009-06-22 20:37:23 +00007752 if (Constructor->isImplicit() && Constructor->isDefaultConstructor()) {
Chandler Carruth4e6fbce2010-08-23 07:55:51 +00007753 if (Constructor->getParent()->hasTrivialConstructor())
7754 return;
7755 if (!Constructor->isUsed(false))
7756 DefineImplicitDefaultConstructor(Loc, Constructor);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007757 } else if (Constructor->isImplicit() &&
Douglas Gregor9e9199d2009-12-22 00:34:07 +00007758 Constructor->isCopyConstructor(TypeQuals)) {
Douglas Gregorc070cc62010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007759 if (!Constructor->isUsed(false))
Fariborz Jahanian485f0872009-06-22 23:34:40 +00007760 DefineImplicitCopyConstructor(Loc, Constructor, TypeQuals);
7761 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007762
Douglas Gregor6fb745b2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007763 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Constructor->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanian8d2b3562009-06-26 23:49:16 +00007764 } else if (CXXDestructorDecl *Destructor = dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregorc070cc62010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007765 if (Destructor->isImplicit() && !Destructor->isUsed(false))
Fariborz Jahanian8d2b3562009-06-26 23:49:16 +00007766 DefineImplicitDestructor(Loc, Destructor);
Douglas Gregor6fb745b2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007767 if (Destructor->isVirtual())
7768 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Destructor->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanianc75bc2d2009-06-25 21:45:19 +00007769 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *MethodDecl = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D)) {
7770 if (MethodDecl->isImplicit() && MethodDecl->isOverloadedOperator() &&
7771 MethodDecl->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_Equal) {
Douglas Gregorc070cc62010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007772 if (!MethodDecl->isUsed(false))
Douglas Gregor39957dc2010-05-01 15:04:51 +00007773 DefineImplicitCopyAssignment(Loc, MethodDecl);
Douglas Gregor6fb745b2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007774 } else if (MethodDecl->isVirtual())
7775 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, MethodDecl->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanianc75bc2d2009-06-25 21:45:19 +00007776 }
Fariborz Jahanianf5ed9e02009-06-24 22:09:44 +00007777 if (FunctionDecl *Function = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007778 // Implicit instantiation of function templates and member functions of
Douglas Gregor1637be72009-06-26 00:10:03 +00007779 // class templates.
Douglas Gregor6cfacfe2010-05-17 17:34:56 +00007780 if (Function->isImplicitlyInstantiable()) {
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007781 bool AlreadyInstantiated = false;
7782 if (FunctionTemplateSpecializationInfo *SpecInfo
7783 = Function->getTemplateSpecializationInfo()) {
7784 if (SpecInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
7785 SpecInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007786 else if (SpecInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregor3b846b62009-10-27 20:53:28 +00007787 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007788 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007789 } else if (MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007790 = Function->getMemberSpecializationInfo()) {
7791 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
7792 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007793 else if (MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregor3b846b62009-10-27 20:53:28 +00007794 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007795 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
7796 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007797
Douglas Gregor60406be2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00007798 if (!AlreadyInstantiated) {
7799 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext()) &&
7800 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext())->isLocalClass())
7801 PendingLocalImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function,
7802 Loc));
7803 else
Chandler Carruth62c78d52010-08-25 08:44:16 +00007804 PendingInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function, Loc));
Douglas Gregor60406be2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00007805 }
Gabor Greif40181c42010-08-28 00:16:06 +00007806 } else // Walk redefinitions, as some of them may be instantiable.
7807 for (FunctionDecl::redecl_iterator i(Function->redecls_begin()),
7808 e(Function->redecls_end()); i != e; ++i) {
Gabor Greifbe9ebe32010-08-28 01:58:12 +00007809 if (!i->isUsed(false) && i->isImplicitlyInstantiable())
Gabor Greif40181c42010-08-28 00:16:06 +00007810 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, *i);
7811 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007812
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007813 // FIXME: keep track of references to static functions
Argyrios Kyrtzidis58b52592010-08-25 10:34:54 +00007814
7815 // Recursive functions should be marked when used from another function.
7816 if (CurContext != Function)
7817 Function->setUsed(true);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007818
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007819 return;
Douglas Gregord7f37bf2009-06-22 23:06:13 +00007820 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007821
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007822 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor7caa6822009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007823 // Implicit instantiation of static data members of class templates.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007824 if (Var->isStaticDataMember() &&
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007825 Var->getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember()) {
7826 MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo = Var->getMemberSpecializationInfo();
7827 assert(MSInfo && "Missing member specialization information?");
7828 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid() &&
7829 MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()== TSK_ImplicitInstantiation) {
7830 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Chandler Carruth62c78d52010-08-25 08:44:16 +00007831 PendingInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Var, Loc));
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007832 }
7833 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007834
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007835 // FIXME: keep track of references to static data?
Douglas Gregor7caa6822009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007836
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007837 D->setUsed(true);
Douglas Gregor7caa6822009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007838 return;
Sam Weinigcce6ebc2009-09-11 03:29:30 +00007839 }
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007840}
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007841
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007842namespace {
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007843 // Mark all of the declarations referenced
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007844 // FIXME: Not fully implemented yet! We need to have a better understanding
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007845 // of when we're entering
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007846 class MarkReferencedDecls : public RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> {
7847 Sema &S;
7848 SourceLocation Loc;
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007849
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007850 public:
7851 typedef RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> Inherited;
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007852
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007853 MarkReferencedDecls(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc) : S(S), Loc(Loc) { }
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007854
7855 bool TraverseTemplateArgument(const TemplateArgument &Arg);
7856 bool TraverseRecordType(RecordType *T);
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007857 };
7858}
7859
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007860bool MarkReferencedDecls::TraverseTemplateArgument(
7861 const TemplateArgument &Arg) {
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007862 if (Arg.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Declaration) {
7863 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, Arg.getAsDecl());
7864 }
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007865
7866 return Inherited::TraverseTemplateArgument(Arg);
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007867}
7868
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007869bool MarkReferencedDecls::TraverseRecordType(RecordType *T) {
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007870 if (ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *Spec
7871 = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(T->getDecl())) {
7872 const TemplateArgumentList &Args = Spec->getTemplateArgs();
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007873 return TraverseTemplateArguments(Args.getFlatArgumentList(),
7874 Args.flat_size());
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007875 }
7876
Chandler Carruthe3e210c2010-06-10 10:31:57 +00007877 return true;
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007878}
7879
7880void Sema::MarkDeclarationsReferencedInType(SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) {
7881 MarkReferencedDecls Marker(*this, Loc);
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007882 Marker.TraverseType(Context.getCanonicalType(T));
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007883}
7884
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00007885namespace {
7886 /// \brief Helper class that marks all of the declarations referenced by
7887 /// potentially-evaluated subexpressions as "referenced".
7888 class EvaluatedExprMarker : public EvaluatedExprVisitor<EvaluatedExprMarker> {
7889 Sema &S;
7890
7891 public:
7892 typedef EvaluatedExprVisitor<EvaluatedExprMarker> Inherited;
7893
7894 explicit EvaluatedExprMarker(Sema &S) : Inherited(S.Context), S(S) { }
7895
7896 void VisitDeclRefExpr(DeclRefExpr *E) {
7897 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocation(), E->getDecl());
7898 }
7899
7900 void VisitMemberExpr(MemberExpr *E) {
7901 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getMemberLoc(), E->getMemberDecl());
Douglas Gregor4fcf5b22010-09-11 23:32:50 +00007902 Inherited::VisitMemberExpr(E);
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00007903 }
7904
7905 void VisitCXXNewExpr(CXXNewExpr *E) {
7906 if (E->getConstructor())
7907 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getConstructor());
7908 if (E->getOperatorNew())
7909 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getOperatorNew());
7910 if (E->getOperatorDelete())
7911 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getOperatorDelete());
Douglas Gregor4fcf5b22010-09-11 23:32:50 +00007912 Inherited::VisitCXXNewExpr(E);
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00007913 }
7914
7915 void VisitCXXDeleteExpr(CXXDeleteExpr *E) {
7916 if (E->getOperatorDelete())
7917 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getOperatorDelete());
Douglas Gregor5833b0b2010-09-14 22:55:20 +00007918 QualType Destroyed = S.Context.getBaseElementType(E->getDestroyedType());
7919 if (const RecordType *DestroyedRec = Destroyed->getAs<RecordType>()) {
7920 CXXRecordDecl *Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DestroyedRec->getDecl());
7921 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(),
7922 S.LookupDestructor(Record));
7923 }
7924
Douglas Gregor4fcf5b22010-09-11 23:32:50 +00007925 Inherited::VisitCXXDeleteExpr(E);
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00007926 }
7927
7928 void VisitCXXConstructExpr(CXXConstructExpr *E) {
7929 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getConstructor());
Douglas Gregor4fcf5b22010-09-11 23:32:50 +00007930 Inherited::VisitCXXConstructExpr(E);
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00007931 }
7932
7933 void VisitBlockDeclRefExpr(BlockDeclRefExpr *E) {
7934 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocation(), E->getDecl());
7935 }
7936 };
7937}
7938
7939/// \brief Mark any declarations that appear within this expression or any
7940/// potentially-evaluated subexpressions as "referenced".
7941void Sema::MarkDeclarationsReferencedInExpr(Expr *E) {
7942 EvaluatedExprMarker(*this).Visit(E);
7943}
7944
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007945/// \brief Emit a diagnostic that describes an effect on the run-time behavior
7946/// of the program being compiled.
7947///
7948/// This routine emits the given diagnostic when the code currently being
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007949/// type-checked is "potentially evaluated", meaning that there is a
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007950/// possibility that the code will actually be executable. Code in sizeof()
7951/// expressions, code used only during overload resolution, etc., are not
7952/// potentially evaluated. This routine will suppress such diagnostics or,
7953/// in the absolutely nutty case of potentially potentially evaluated
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007954/// expressions (C++ typeid), queue the diagnostic to potentially emit it
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007955/// later.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007956///
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007957/// This routine should be used for all diagnostics that describe the run-time
7958/// behavior of a program, such as passing a non-POD value through an ellipsis.
7959/// Failure to do so will likely result in spurious diagnostics or failures
7960/// during overload resolution or within sizeof/alignof/typeof/typeid.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007961bool Sema::DiagRuntimeBehavior(SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007962 const PartialDiagnostic &PD) {
7963 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context ) {
7964 case Unevaluated:
7965 // The argument will never be evaluated, so don't complain.
7966 break;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007967
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007968 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00007969 case PotentiallyEvaluatedIfUsed:
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007970 Diag(Loc, PD);
7971 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007972
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007973 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
7974 ExprEvalContexts.back().addDiagnostic(Loc, PD);
7975 break;
7976 }
7977
7978 return false;
7979}
7980
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007981bool Sema::CheckCallReturnType(QualType ReturnType, SourceLocation Loc,
7982 CallExpr *CE, FunctionDecl *FD) {
7983 if (ReturnType->isVoidType() || !ReturnType->isIncompleteType())
7984 return false;
7985
7986 PartialDiagnostic Note =
7987 FD ? PDiag(diag::note_function_with_incomplete_return_type_declared_here)
7988 << FD->getDeclName() : PDiag();
7989 SourceLocation NoteLoc = FD ? FD->getLocation() : SourceLocation();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007990
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007991 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, ReturnType,
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007992 FD ?
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007993 PDiag(diag::err_call_function_incomplete_return)
7994 << CE->getSourceRange() << FD->getDeclName() :
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007995 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_return)
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007996 << CE->getSourceRange(),
7997 std::make_pair(NoteLoc, Note)))
7998 return true;
7999
8000 return false;
8001}
8002
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008003// Diagnose the common s/=/==/ typo. Note that adding parentheses
8004// will prevent this condition from triggering, which is what we want.
8005void Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(Expr *E) {
8006 SourceLocation Loc;
8007
John McCalla52ef082009-11-11 02:41:58 +00008008 unsigned diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_assignment;
8009
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008010 if (isa<BinaryOperator>(E)) {
8011 BinaryOperator *Op = cast<BinaryOperator>(E);
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00008012 if (Op->getOpcode() != BO_Assign)
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008013 return;
8014
John McCallc8d8ac52009-11-12 00:06:05 +00008015 // Greylist some idioms by putting them into a warning subcategory.
8016 if (ObjCMessageExpr *ME
8017 = dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>(Op->getRHS()->IgnoreParenCasts())) {
8018 Selector Sel = ME->getSelector();
8019
John McCallc8d8ac52009-11-12 00:06:05 +00008020 // self = [<foo> init...]
8021 if (isSelfExpr(Op->getLHS())
8022 && Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName().startswith("init"))
8023 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
8024
8025 // <foo> = [<bar> nextObject]
8026 else if (Sel.isUnarySelector() &&
8027 Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName() == "nextObject")
8028 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
8029 }
John McCalla52ef082009-11-11 02:41:58 +00008030
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008031 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
8032 } else if (isa<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E)) {
8033 CXXOperatorCallExpr *Op = cast<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E);
8034 if (Op->getOperator() != OO_Equal)
8035 return;
8036
8037 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
8038 } else {
8039 // Not an assignment.
8040 return;
8041 }
8042
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008043 SourceLocation Open = E->getSourceRange().getBegin();
John McCall2d152152009-10-12 22:25:59 +00008044 SourceLocation Close = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(E->getSourceRange().getEnd());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008045
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00008046 Diag(Loc, diagnostic) << E->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00008047 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_to_comparison)
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00008048 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(Loc, "==");
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00008049 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_silence)
8050 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Open, "(")
8051 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Close, ")");
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008052}
8053
8054bool Sema::CheckBooleanCondition(Expr *&E, SourceLocation Loc) {
8055 DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(E);
8056
8057 if (!E->isTypeDependent()) {
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00008058 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(E);
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008059
8060 QualType T = E->getType();
8061
8062 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
8063 if (CheckCXXBooleanCondition(E)) // C++ 6.4p4
8064 return true;
8065 } else if (!T->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.8.4.1p1
8066 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_statement_requires_scalar)
8067 << T << E->getSourceRange();
8068 return true;
8069 }
8070 }
8071
8072 return false;
8073}
Douglas Gregor586596f2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00008074
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00008075ExprResult Sema::ActOnBooleanCondition(Scope *S, SourceLocation Loc,
8076 Expr *Sub) {
Douglas Gregoreecf38f2010-05-06 21:39:56 +00008077 if (!Sub)
Douglas Gregor586596f2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00008078 return ExprError();
8079
Douglas Gregorff331c12010-07-25 18:17:45 +00008080 if (CheckBooleanCondition(Sub, Loc))
Douglas Gregor586596f2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00008081 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor586596f2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00008082
8083 return Owned(Sub);
8084}